Untitled
Untitled
Untitled
User’s Guide
Version: 4.2
Firmware Version: V3.8.4
(For future update, please visit DrayTek web site)
Date: October 18, 2016
ii
Vigor2860 Series User’s Guide
Copyrights
© All rights reserved. This publication contains information that is protected by copyright. No part may be
reproduced, transmitted, transcribed, stored in a retrieval system, or translated into any language without
written permission from the copyright holders.
Trademarks
The following trademarks are used in this document:
Microsoft is a registered trademark of Microsoft Corp.
Windows, Windows 95, 98, Me, NT, 2000, XP, Vista, 7 and Explorer are trademarks of Microsoft Corp.
Apple and Mac OS are registered trademarks of Apple Inc.
Other products may be trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective manufacturers.
Safety Instructions
Read the installation guide thoroughly before you set up the router.
The router is a complicated electronic unit that may be repaired only be authorized and qualified personnel.
Do not try to open or repair the router yourself.
Do not place the router in a damp or humid place, e.g. a bathroom.
The router should be used in a sheltered area, within a temperature range of +5 to +40 Celsius.
Do not expose the router to direct sunlight or other heat sources. The housing and electronic components
may be damaged by direct sunlight or heat sources.
Do not deploy the cable for LAN connection outdoor to prevent electronic shock hazards.
Keep the package out of reach of children.
When you want to dispose of the router, please follow local regulations on conservation of the environment.
Warranty
We warrant to the original end user (purchaser) that the router will be free from any defects in workmanship
or materials for a period of two (2) years from the date of purchase from the dealer. Please keep your
purchase receipt in a safe place as it serves as proof of date of purchase. During the warranty period, and upon
proof of purchase, should the product have indications of failure due to faulty workmanship and/or materials,
we will, at our discretion, repair or replace the defective products or components, without charge for either
parts or labor, to whatever extent we deem necessary tore-store the product to proper operating condition.
Any replacement will consist of a new or re-manufactured functionally equivalent product of equal value, and
will be offered solely at our discretion. This warranty will not apply if the product is modified, misused,
tampered with, damaged by an act of God, or subjected to abnormal working conditions. The warranty does
not cover the bundled or licensed software of other vendors. Defects which do not significantly affect the
usability of the product will not be covered by the warranty. We reserve the right to revise the manual and
online documentation and to make changes from time to time in the contents hereof without obligation to
notify any person of such revision or changes.
Be a Registered Owner
Web registration is preferred. You can register your Vigor router via http://www.DrayTek.com.
Firmware & Tools Updates
Due to the continuous evolution of DrayTek technology, all routers will be regularly upgraded. Please consult
the DrayTek web site for more information on newest firmware, tools and documents.
http://www.DrayTek.com
iv
Vigor2860 Series User’s Guide
Table of Contents
Part I Installation .................................................................................................................i
I-1 Introduction ................................................................................................................................... 1
I-1-1 Indicators and Connectors .................................................................................................. 2
I-1-1-1 For Vigor2860 / Vigor2860L .............................................................. 2
I-1-1-2 For Vigor2860ac / Vigor2860n-plus / Vigor2860n/Vigor2860Ln ..................... 5
I-1-1-3 For Vigor2860Vac / Vigor2860Vn-plus .................................................10
I-2 Hardware Installation .................................................................................................................. 12
I-2-1 Installing Vigor Router ....................................................................................................... 12
I-2-2 Installing USB Printer to Vigor Router ............................................................................... 13
I-3 Accessing Web Page .................................................................................................................. 21
I-4 Changing Password.................................................................................................................... 23
I-5 Dashboard................................................................................................................................... 25
I-5-1 Virtual Panel ...................................................................................................................... 26
I-5-2 Name with a Link ............................................................................................................... 26
I-5-3 Quick Access for Common Used Menu ............................................................................ 27
I-5-4 Topology – Switch Management ....................................................................................... 28
I-5-5 GUI Map ............................................................................................................................ 29
I-5-6 Web Console ..................................................................................................................... 30
I-5-7 Config Backup ................................................................................................................... 31
I-5-8 Logout................................................................................................................................ 31
I-5-9 Online Status ..................................................................................................................... 32
I-5-9-1 Physical Connection ......................................................................32
I-5-9-2 Virtual WAN ...............................................................................34
I-6 Quick Start Wizard ...................................................................................................................... 35
I-6-1 For WAN1 (ADSL/VDSL2) ................................................................................................ 36
I-6-2 For WAN2 (Ethernet)/(Wireless 2.4G)............................................................................... 42
I-6-3 For WAN3/WAN4 (USB).................................................................................................... 57
I-6-4 For LTE WAN .................................................................................................................... 59
I-7 Service Activation Wizard ........................................................................................................... 61
I-8 Registering Vigor Router............................................................................................................. 64
vi
Vigor2860 Series User’s Guide
II-5-3-1 General Setup .......................................................................... 194
II-5-3-2 Domain Diagnose ....................................................................... 195
II-5-4 Schedule......................................................................................................................... 196
II-5-5 RADIUS/TACACS+ ........................................................................................................ 198
II-5-5-1 External RADIUS ........................................................................ 198
II-5-5-2 Internal RADIUS ........................................................................ 199
II-5-5-3 External TACACS+...................................................................... 201
II-5-6 Active Directory/LDAP .................................................................................................... 203
II-5-6-1 General Setup .......................................................................... 203
II-5-6-2 Profiles .................................................................................. 204
II-5-7 UPnP .............................................................................................................................. 206
II-5-8 IGMP............................................................................................................................... 207
II-5-9 Wake on LAN ................................................................................................................. 208
II-5-10 SMS / Mail Alert Service............................................................................................... 209
II-5-10-1 SMS Alert............................................................................... 209
II-5-10-2 Mail Alert .............................................................................. 210
II-5-11 Bonjour ......................................................................................................................... 211
II-5-12 High Availability ............................................................................................................ 214
II-5-12-1 General Setup ......................................................................... 216
II-5-12-2 Config Sync ............................................................................ 217
II-5-13 Local 802.1X General Setup ........................................................................................ 219
Application Notes ..................................................................................................................... 221
A-1 How to Implement the LDAP/AD Authentication for User Management? ......... 221
A-2 How to Configure Customized DDNS?.................................................... 224
II-6 Routing..................................................................................................................................... 228
Web User Interface .................................................................................................................. 229
II-6-1 Static Route .................................................................................................................... 229
II-6-2 Load-Balance /Route Policy ........................................................................................... 234
II-6-2-1 General Setup .......................................................................... 234
II-6-2-2 Diagnose ................................................................................. 239
Application Notes ..................................................................................................................... 242
A-1 How to Customize a Secure Route between VPN Router and Remote Router by Using
Route Policy ...................................................................................... 242
A-2 How to Setup Address Mapping........................................................... 246
A-3 How to setup Load Balance for Packets?................................................ 250
II-7 LTE ........................................................................................................................................... 252
Web User Interface .................................................................................................................. 253
II-7-1 General Settings............................................................................................................. 253
II-7-2 SMS Inbox ...................................................................................................................... 255
II-7-3 Send SMS ...................................................................................................................... 258
II-7-4 Router Commands ......................................................................................................... 259
II-7-5 Status ............................................................................................................................. 261
Part IV VoIP.....................................................................................................................295
IV-1 VoIP ........................................................................................................................................ 296
Web User Interface .................................................................................................................. 298
IV-1-1 VoIP Wizard .................................................................................................................. 298
IV-1-2 General Settings ........................................................................................................... 300
IV-1-3 SIP Accounts................................................................................................................. 303
IV-1-4 DialPlan......................................................................................................................... 308
IV-1-4-1 Phone Book ............................................................................. 308
IV-1-4-2 Digit Map ............................................................................... 310
IV-1-4-3 Call Barring ............................................................................ 312
IV-1-4-4 Regional ................................................................................ 314
IV-1-4-5 PSTN Setup ............................................................................. 315
IV-1-5 Phone Settings.............................................................................................................. 316
IV-1-6 Status ............................................................................................................................ 320
viii
Vigor2860 Series User’s Guide
A-1 How to Build a LAN-to-LAN VPN Between Remote Office and Headquarter via IPsec
Tunnel (Main Mode) ............................................................................. 366
A-2 How to use ZenMate service on Vigor Router? ......................................... 371
V-2 SSL VPN .................................................................................................................................. 376
Web User Interface .................................................................................................................. 377
V-2-1 General Setup ................................................................................................................ 377
V-2-2 SSL Web Proxy.............................................................................................................. 378
V-2-3 SSL Application.............................................................................................................. 380
V-2-4 User Account.................................................................................................................. 382
V-2-5 User Group..................................................................................................................... 386
V-2-6 Online User Status ......................................................................................................... 388
V-3 Certificate Management........................................................................................................... 389
Web User Interface .................................................................................................................. 390
V-3-1 Local Certificate ............................................................................................................. 390
V-3-2 Trusted CA Certificate.................................................................................................... 394
V-3-3 Certificate Backup .......................................................................................................... 396
x
Vigor2860 Series User’s Guide
A-1 CVM Application - How to manage the CPE (router) through Vigor2860 series? . 548
A-2 CVM Application - How to build the VPN between remote devices and Vigor2860
series? ............................................................................................. 552
A-3 CVM Application - How to upgrade CPE firmware through Vigor2860 series? .... 554
VII-5 Central Management (AP)..................................................................................................... 557
Web User Interface .................................................................................................................. 558
VII-5-1 Dashboard.................................................................................................................... 558
VII-5-2 Status ........................................................................................................................... 559
VII-5-3 WLAN Profile................................................................................................................ 560
VII-5-4 AP Maintenance........................................................................................................... 565
VII-5-5 AP Map ........................................................................................................................ 566
VII-5-6 Traffic Graph ................................................................................................................ 569
VII-5-7 Temperature Sensor .................................................................................................... 570
VII-5-8 Rogue AP Detection..................................................................................................... 570
VII-5-9 Event Log ..................................................................................................................... 574
VII-5-10 Total Traffic ................................................................................................................ 574
VII-5-11 Station Number .......................................................................................................... 575
VII-5-12 Load Balance ............................................................................................................. 575
VII-5-13 Function Support List ................................................................................................. 576
Application Notes ..................................................................................................................... 577
A-1 How to use AP Management function (in Vigor2860) to check AP status and deploy
WLAN profile ..................................................................................... 577
VII-6 Central Management (Switch) ............................................................................................... 580
VII-6-1 Status ........................................................................................................................... 580
VII-6-1-1 Switch Status.......................................................................... 580
VII-6-1-2 Switch Hierarchy ..................................................................... 582
VII-6-2 Profile ........................................................................................................................... 583
VII-6-3 Group ........................................................................................................................... 586
VII-6-4 Maintenance................................................................................................................. 588
VII-6-5 Support List .................................................................................................................. 589
VII-7 Central Management (External Devices) .............................................................................. 590
VII-7-1 All Devices ................................................................................................................... 590
xii
Vigor2860 Series User’s Guide
IX-3 Checking If the Network Connection Settings on Your Computer Is OK or Not..................... 661
IX-4 Pinging the Router from Your Computer ................................................................................ 664
IX-5 Checking If the ISP Settings are OK or Not............................................................................ 666
IX-6 Problems for 3G/4G Network Connection .............................................................................. 667
IX-7 Backing to Factory Default Setting If Necessary .................................................................... 668
IX-8 Contacting DrayTek ................................................................................................................ 670
Appendix I: VLAN Applications on Vigor Router ............................................................................ 671
Index ...............................................................................................................................879
Interface Description
Factory Reset Restore the default settings. Usage: Turn on the router (ACT LED is
blinking). Press the hole and keep for more than 5 seconds. When you
see the ACT LED begins to blink rapidly than usual, release the button.
Then the router will restart with the factory default configuration.
USB1~2 / USB Connecter for a USB device (for 3G/4G USB Modem or printer).
VDSL/ADSL Connecter for accessing the Internet.
WAN2 Connecter for local network devices or modem for accessing Internet.
GigaLAN (1-6) Connecters for local network devices.
PWR Connecter for a power adapter.
ON/OFF Power Switch.
SIM Card Slot Connector for a SIM card.
Antenna
Socket
SIM Card
Slot
Antenna
Socket
Note, if only one antenna shall be installed, please use the mounting hole (major signal
transmitted hole) near to the SIM card slot.
While installing the SIM card into the card slot, note that back plate of the SIM card slot must
be removed first and the direction of card notch must be on the left side.
Interface Description
Wireless LAN For Vigor2860n :
ON/OFF/WPS Press the button and release it within 2 seconds. When the
wireless function is ready, the green LED will be on.
Press the button and release it within 2 seconds to turn off the
WLAN function. When the wireless function is not ready, the
Antenna
Socket
Major Signal
Transmitted Hole
SIM Card
Slot
Note, if only one antenna shall be installed, please use the mounting hole (major signal
transmitted hole) near to the SIM card slot.
While installing the SIM card into the card slot, note that back plate of the SIM card slot must
be removed first and the direction of card notch must be on the left side.
Holes for
Antennas without
Socket
Before using it, please follow the steps below to configure settings for connected computers
(or wireless clients).
1. Connect the printer with the router through USB/parallel port.
2. Open All Programs>>Getting Started>>Devices and Printers.
5. In this dialog, choose Create a new port. In the field of Type of port, use the drop down
list to select Standard TCP/IP Port. Then, click Next.
13. Edit the property of the new printer you have added by clicking Configure Port.
Info Some printers with the fax/scanning or other additional functions are not
supported.
Vigor router supports printing request from computers via LAN ports but not
WAN port.
Info If you fail to access to the web configuration, please go to “Trouble Shooting” for
detecting and solving your problem.
Info The home page will be different slightly in accordance with the type of the
router you have.
5. The web page can be logged out according to the chosen condition. The default setting
is Auto Logout, which means the web configuration system will logout after 5 minutes
without any operation. Change the setting for your necessity.
Please change the password for the original security of the router.
1. Open a web browser on your PC and type http://192.168.1.1. A pop-up window will
open to ask for username and password.
2. Please type “admin/admin” as Username/Password for accessing into the web user
interface with admin mode.
3. Go to System Maintenance page and choose Administrator Password.
4. Enter the login password (the default is “admin”) on the field of Old Password. Type
New Password and Confirm Password. Then click OK to continue.
Info The maximum length of the password you can set is 23 characters.
5. Now, the password has been changed. Next time, use the new password to access the
Web user interface for this router.
Dashboard shows the connection status including System Information, IPv4 Internet Access,
IPv6 Internet Access, Interface (physical connection), Security and Quick Access.
Click Dashboard from the main menu on the left side of the main page.
A web page with default selections will be displayed on the screen. Refer to the following
figure:
For detailed information about the LED display, refer to I-1-1 LED Indicators and
Connectors.
The function links of System Status, Dynamic DDNS, TR-069, User Management, IM/P2P Block,
Schedule, Syslog/Mail Alert, LDAP, RADIUS, Firewall Object Setting and Data Flow Monitor are
displayed here. Move your mouse cursor on any one of the links and click on it. The
corresponding setting page will be open immediately.
In addition, quick access for VPN security settings such as Remote Dial-in User and LAN to
LAN are located on the bottom of this page. Scroll down the page to find them and use them
if required.
Note that there is a plus ( ) icon located on the left side of VPN/LAN. Click it to review the
VPN connection(s) used presently.
All the functions the router supports are listed with table clearly in this page. Users can click
the function link to access into the setting page of the function for detailed configuration.
Click the icon on the top of the main screen to display all the functions.
It is not necessary to use the telnet command via DOS prompt. The changes made by using
web console have the same effects as modified through web user interface. The
functions/settings modified under Web Console also can be reviewed on the web user
interface.
Click the Web Console icon on the top of the main screen to open the following screen.
There is one way to store current used settings quickly by clicking the Config Backup icon. It
allows you to backup current settings as a file. Such configuration file can be restored by
using System Maintenance>>Configuration Backup.
Simply click the icon on the top of the main screen and a pop up dialog will appear.
I-5-8 Logout
Item Description
LAN Status Primary DNS-Displays the primary DNS server address for
WAN interface.
Secondary DNS -Displays the secondary DNS server address
for WAN interface.
IP Address-Displays the IP address of the LAN interface.
TX Packets-Displays the total transmitted packets at the
LAN interface.
RX Packets-Displays the total received packets at the LAN
interface.
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3 Enable – Yes in red means such interface is available but
/WAN4 Status not enabled. Yes in green means such interface is enabled.
Line – Displays the physical connection (VDSL, ADSL,
Ethernet, or USB) of this interface.
Name – Display the name of the router.
Mode - Displays the type of WAN connection (e.g., PPPoE).
Up Time - Displays the total uptime of the interface.
IP - Displays the IP address of the WAN interface.
GW IP - Displays the IP address of the default gateway.
TX Packets - Displays the total transmitted packets at the
WAN interface.
TX Rate - Displays the speed of transmitted octets at the
WAN interface.
RX Packets - Displays the total number of received packets
at the WAN interface.
RX Rate - Displays the speed of received octets at the WAN
interface.
Info The words in green mean that the WAN connection of that interface is ready for
accessing Internet; the words in red mean that the WAN connection of that interface
is not ready for accessing Internet.
Quick Start Wizard can help you to deploy and use the router easily and quickly. Go to
Wizards>>Quick Start Wizard. The first screen of Quick Start Wizard is entering login
password. After typing the password, please click Next.
On the next page as shown below, please select the WAN interface that you use. If DSL
interface is used, please choose WAN1; if Ethernet interface is used, please choose WAN2; if
3G USB modem is used, please choose WAN3 or WAN4; if LTE SIM card is used, please choose
LTE. Then click Next for next step.
WAN1, WAN2, WAN3/LTE and WAN4 will bring up different configuration page. Refer to the
following for detailed information. In which, WAN3 will be treated as USB WAN or LTE WAN
according to the USB modem or SIM Card used for accessing Internet.
Item Description
Display Name Type a name to identify such WAN.
DSL Mode Specify the physical mode (VDSL2 only or ADSL only) for such
router manually.
VLAN Tag insertion The settings configured in this field are available for WAN1
(VDSL2)/(ADSL) and WAN2.
Enable – Enable the function of VLAN with tag.
The router will add specific VLAN number to all packets on
the WAN while sending them out.
Please type the tag value and specify the priority for the
packets sending by WAN1.
Disable – Disable the function of VLAN with tag.
Tag value – Type the value as the VLAN ID number. The range
is from 0 to 4095.
Priority – Type the packet priority number for such VLAN.
The range is from 0 to 7.
You have to select the appropriate Internet access type according to the information from
your ISP. For example, you should select PPPoE mode if the ISP provides you PPPoE interface.
In addition, the field of For ADSL Only will be available only when ADSL is detected. Then
click Next for next step.
Item Description
Protocol There are two modes offered for you to choose for WAN1
interface.
2. After finished the above settings, simply click Next. Manually enter the
Username/Password provided by your ISP
Item Description
Service Name Enter the description of the specific network service.
(Optional)
Username Assign a specific valid user name provided by the ISP.
Note: The maximum length of the user name you can set is
63 characters.
Password Assign a valid password provided by the ISP.
Note: The maximum length of the password you can set is 62
characters.
Confirm Password Retype the password.
Back Click it to return to previous setting page.
Next Click it to get into the next setting page.
Cancel Click it to give up the quick start wizard.
4. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
Item Description
Protocol There are two modes offered for you to choose for WAN1
interface.
3. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
Item Description
Display Name Type a name for the router.
Physical Mode Choose Ethernet or Wireless based on the physical
connection.
Choose Wireless 2.4G if you want to use wireless station
mode to access Internet. Otherwise, choose Ethernet to
access Internet through WAN2 Ethernet Port.
Physical Type This setting is available when Ethernet is selected as
Physical Mode. In general, Auto negotiation is suggested.
VLAN Tag insertion The settings configured in this field are available when
Ethernet is selected as Physical Mode.
Disable – Disable the function of VLAN with tag.
Enable – Enable the function of VLAN with tag.
The router will add specific VLAN number to all packets on
the WAN while sending them out.
Please type the tag value and specify the priority for the
packets sending by WAN2.
Tag value – Type the value as the VLAN ID number. The
range is form 0 to 4095.
Priority – Type the packet priority number for such
VLAN. The range is from 0 to 7.
On the next page as shown below, please select the appropriate Internet access type
according to the information from your ISP. For example, you should select PPPoE mode if the
ISP provides you PPPoE interface. Then click Next for next step.
2. Click PPPoE as the Internet Access Type. Then click Next to continue.
Item Description
Service Name Enter the description of the specific network service.
(Optional)
Username Assign a specific valid user name provided by the ISP.
Note: The maximum length of the user name you can set is
63 characters.
Password Assign a valid password provided by the ISP.
Note: The maximum length of the password you can set is 62
characters.
3. Please manually enter the Username/Password provided by your ISP. Click Next for
viewing summary of such connection.
4. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
2. Click PPTP/L2TP as the Internet Access Type. Then click Next to continue.
Item Description
Username Assign a specific valid user name provided by the ISP.
Note: The maximum length of the user name you can set is
63 characters.
Password Assign a valid password provided by the ISP.
Note: The maximum length of the password you can set is 62
4. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
2. Click Static IP as the Internet Access type. Simply click Next to continue.
Item Description
WAN IP Type the IP address.
Subnet Mask Type the subnet mask.
Gateway Type the IP address of gateway.
Primary DNS Type in the primary IP address for the router.
Secondary DNS Type in secondary IP address for necessity in the future.
Back Click it to return to previous setting page.
Next Click it to get into the next setting page.
3. Please type in the IP address information originally provided by your ISP. Then click Next
for next step.
4. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
2. Click DHCP as the Internet Access type. Simply click Next to continue.
Item Description
Host Name Type the name of the host.
Note: The maximum length of the host name you can set is
39 characters.
MAC Some Cable service providers specify a specific MAC address
for access authentication. In such cases you need to enter
the MAC address.
Back Click it to return to previous setting page.
Next Click it to get into the next setting page.
Cancel Click it to give up the quick start wizard.
3. After finished the settings above, click Next for viewing summary of such connection.
2. Click Static IP as the Internet Access Type. Simply click Next to continue.
Item Description
WAN IP Type the IP address.
3. Please type in the IP address information according to the settings of your Wireless AP.
Then click Next for next step.
Item Description
SSID The identification of the Wireless AP.
MAC Address The MAC Address of the Wireless AP.
(Optional)
Channel The channel of frequency of the Wireless AP. Please notice
that, if this setting is modified, the channel of Wireless LAN
(2.4GHz) would be also modified.
Security Mode The mode to connect to the Wireless AP.
Disable – The Router connects to the wireless AP
without any encryption mechanism.
WEP – The Router connects to the wireless AP as a WEP
client and the encryption key should be entered in WEP
Key.
WPA/PSK – The Router connects to the wireless AP as a
WPA client and the encryption key should be entered in
PSK.
WPA2/PSK – The Router connects to the wireless AP as a
WPA2 client and the encryption key should be entered
in PSK.
Back Click it to return to previous setting page.
Next Click it to get into the next setting page.
Cancel Click it to give up the quick start wizard.
5. Click the Scan button of the popup window and wait for a few seconds.
8. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
2. Click DHCP as the Internet Access type. Simply click Next to continue.
Item Description
SSID The identification of the Wireless AP.
MAC Address The MAC Address of the Wireless AP.
(Optional)
Channel The channel of frequency of the Wireless AP. Please notice
that, if this setting is modified, the channel of Wireless LAN
(2.4GHz) would be also modified.
Security Mode The mode to connect to the Wireless AP.
Disable – The Router connects to the wireless AP
3. Click the AP Discovery button to choose your Wireless AP. You can also set the Wireless
AP information directly and skip the next 2 steps.
4. Click the Scan button of the popup window and wait for a few seconds.
6. All settings except the encryption key will be filled automatically. If the Security Mode
is WEP, type in the WEP Keys. If the Security Mode is WPA/PSK or WPA2/PSK, type in
the Pass Phrase. Then click Next for next step.
7. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
Item Description
Internet Access Choose one of the selections as the protocol of accessing the
internet.
3G/4G USB Modem SIM Pin code –Type PIN code of the SIM card that will be used
(PPP mode) to access Internet. The maximum length of the pin code you
can set is 15 characters.
Modem Initial String – Such value is used to initialize USB
modem. Please use the default value. If you have any
question, please contact to your ISP. The maximum length of
4. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
Item Description
Internet Access Now, DHCP mode is the only choice for LTE WAN.
3G/4G USB Modem SIM Pin code – Type PIN code of the SIM card that will be
(DHCP mode) used to access Internet.
Network Mode – Force Vigor router to connect Internet with
the mode specified here. If you choose 4G/3G/2G as network
mode, the router will choose a suitable one according to the
actual wireless signal automatically.
APN Name – APN means Access Point Name which is provided
and required by some ISPs.
4. Click Finish. A page of Quick Start Wizard Setup OK!!! will appear. Then, the system
status of this protocol will be shown.
Service Activation Wizard can guide you to activate WCF service (Web Content Filter) with a
quick and easy way. For the Service Activation Wizard is only available for admin
operation, therefore, please type “admin/admin” on Username/Password while Logging
into the web user interface.
Service Activation Wizard is a tool which allows you to use trial version of WCF directly
without accessing into the server (MyVigor) located on http://myvigor.draytek.com. For
using Web Content Filter Profile, please refer to later section Web Content Filter Profile for
detailed information.
Now, follow the steps listed below to activate WCF feature for your router.
2. The screen of Service Activation Wizard will be shown as follows. Click Next to activate
free trail edition.
Free trial edition: it offers a period of trial for you to get acquainted with WCF function.
Info Commtouch is the web content filter based on Commtouch operated in the
worldwide. There is a 30-day trial period. After trial, you can purchase
DrayTek's prepared Commtouch GlobalView WCF package from retailing
outlets.
BPjM is WCF for German Speaking users. The fragfINN is whitelist for German
Speaking users. The BPjM is ideal for your family to provide more Internet
security for youngsters.
Web Content Filter (fragFINN) service will not be supported since January 1,
2015.
When such page appears, you can enable or disable these services for your necessity.
Then, click Finish.
Info The service will be activated and applied as the default rule configured in
Firewall>>General Setup.
6. Now, the web page will display the service that you have activated according to your
selection(s). The valid time for the free trial of these services is one month.
When all the trial editions for various web content filters had been enabled, the
configuration page of Service Activation Wizard will be invalid as shown below.
You have finished the configuration of Quick Start Wizard and you can surf the Internet at any
time. Now it is the time to register your Vigor router to MyVigor website for getting more
service. Please follow the steps below to finish the router registration.
1 Please login the web configuration interface of Vigor router by typing “admin/admin” as
User Name / Password.
3 A Login page will be shown on the screen. Please type the account and password that
you created previously. And click Login.
4 The following page will be displayed after you logging in MyVigor. From this page, please
click Add or Product Registration.
6 When the following page appears, your router information has been added to the
database.
7 After clicking OK, you will see the following page. Your router has been registered to
myvigor website successfully.
LTE Application
Item Description
II-1-1-1 WAN1(ADSL/VDSL2)
Vigor router will detect the physical line is connected by ADSL or VDSL2 automatically.
Therefore, this page allows you to configure settings for ADSL and VDSL2 at one time. That is,
it is not necessary for you to configure different profile settings for ADSL and VDSL2
respectively.
Item Description
Enable Choose Yes to invoke the settings for this WAN interface.
Choose No to disable the settings for this WAN interface.
Display Name Type the description for such interface.
Physical Mode Display the physical mode of such interface. If VDSL2 is
detected, this field will display “VDSL2”; if ADSL is
detected, it will display “ADSL”.
DSL Mode Specify the physical mode (VDSL or ADSL) for such router
manually.
Physical Type For such interface, no type can be selected.
DSL Modem Code Choose the correct DSL modem code for ensuring the
network connection.
Or,
Item Description
Enable Choose Yes to invoke the settings for this WAN interface.
Choose No to disable the settings for this WAN interface.
Display Name Type the description for such WAN interface.
Physical Mode Choose Wireless 2.4G if you want to use wireless station
mode to access Internet. Otherwise, choose Ethernet to
access Internet through WAN2 Ethernet Port.
DSL Mode Specify the physical mode (VDSL or ADSL) for such router
manually.
DSL Modem Code Choose the correct DSL modem code for ensuring the
network connection.
Item Description
Enable Choose Yes to invoke the settings for this WAN interface.
Choose No to disable the settings for this WAN interface.
Display Name Type the description for such WAN interface.
Item Description
Index Display the WAN interface.
Display Name It shows the name of the WAN1/WAN2/WAN3/WAN4 that
entered in general setup.
Physical Mode It shows the physical connection for
WAN1(ADSL/VDSL2)/WAN2 (Ethernet/Wireless 2.4G)/WAN3
or LTE/WAN4 (3G/4G USB Modem) accroding to the real
network connection.
Access Mode Use the drop down list to choose a proper access mode. The
details page of that mode will be popped up. If not, click
Details Page for accessing the page to configure the
settings.
Details Page This button will open different web page (based on IPv4)
according to the access mode that you choose in WAN
interface.
Note that Details Page will be changed slightly based on
ADSL/VDSL2 physical mode specified on WAN>>General
Setup.
IPv6 This button will open different web page (based on Physical
Mode) to setup IPv6 Internet Access Mode for WAN
interface.
Advanced This button allows you to configure DHCP client options.
DHCP packets can be processed by adding option number
and data information when such function is enabled and
configured.
Item Description
Enable/Disable Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
Modem Setting (for ADSL It is not necessary to configure settings in these fields for
only) modem settings are prepared for ADSL only.
PPPoE Pass-through The router offers PPPoE dial-up connection. Besides, you
also can establish the PPPoE connection directly from local
clients to your ISP via the Vigor router. When PPPoA protocol
is selected, the PPPoE package transmitted by PC will be
transformed into PPPoA package and sent to WAN server.
Thus, the PC can access Internet through such direction.
For Wired LAN – If you check this box, PCs on the same
network can use another set of PPPoE session (different with
the Host PC) to access into Internet.
For Wireless LAN – It is available for n model. If you check
this box, PCs on the same wireless network can use another
set of PPPoE session (different with the Host PC) to access
into Internet.
Item Description
Enable/Disable Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
Modem Setting (for ADSL It is not necessary to configure settings in these fields for
only) modem settings are prepared for ADSL only.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through ARP Detect or Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose ARP Detect, Ping Detect or Always On for
the system to execute for WAN detection. If you choose Ping
Detect as the detection mode, you have to type required
settings for the following items.
Primary/Secondary Ping IP – If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type Primary or Secondary IP
address in this field for pinging.
Ping Gateway IP – If you choose Ping Detect as detection
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
Enable/Disable Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
Modem Settings Set up the DSL parameters required by your ISP. These
(for ADSL only) settings configured here are specified for ADSL only.
Multi-PVC channel - The selections displayed here are
determined by the page of Internet Access >> Multi PVCs.
Select M-PVCs Channel means no selection will be chosen.
VPI - Type in the value provided by ISP.
VCI - Type in the value provided by ISP.
Encapsulating Type - Drop down the list to choose the type
provided by ISP.
Protocol - Drop down the list to choose the one (PPPoE or
PPPoA) provided by ISP.
If you have already used Quick Start Wizard to set the
protocol, then it is not necessary for you to change any
settings in this group.
PPPoE Pass-through The router offers PPPoE dial-up connection. Besides, you
also can establish the PPPoE connection directly from local
clients to your ISP via the Vigor router. When PPPoA protocol
is selected, the PPPoE package transmitted by PC will be
transformed into PPPoA package and sent to WAN server.
Thus, the PC can access Internet through such direction.
For Wired LAN – If you check this box, PCs on the same
network can use another set of PPPoE session (different with
the Host PC) to access into Internet.
For Wireless LAN – It is available for n model. If you check
this box, PCs on the same wireless network can use another
set of PPPoE session (different with the Host PC) to access
into Internet.
Note: To have PPPoA Pass-through, please choose PPPoA
protocol and check the box(es) here. The router will behave
like a modem which only serves the PPPoE client on the LAN.
That’s, the router will offer PPPoA dial-up connection.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through ARP Detect or Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose ARP Detect or Ping Detect for the system to
execute for WAN detection. If you choose Ping Detect as the
detection mode, you have to type required settings for the
following items.
Primary/Secondary Ping IP – If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type Primary or Secondary IP
address in this field for pinging.
Ping Gateway IP – If you choose Ping Detect as detection
mode, you also can enable this setting to use current WAN
gateway IP address for pinging.
With the IP address(es) pinging, Vigor router can check if
the WAN connection is on or off.
TTL (Time to Live) – Set TTL value of PING operation.
Ping Interval – Type the interval for the system to
execute the PING operation.
Ping Retry – Type the number of times that the system is
allowed to execute the PING operation before WAN
disconnection is judged.
MTU It means Max Transmit Unit for packet.
Path MTU Discovery – It is used to detect the maximum MTU
size of a packet not to be segmented in specific transmit
path.
Click Detect to open the following dialog.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
Enable/Disable Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
Modem Settings (for ADSL Set up the DSL parameters required by your ISP. These
only) settings configured here are specified for ADSL only.
Multi-PVC channel - The selections displayed here are
determined by the page of Internet Access >>Multi PVCs.
Select M-PVCs Channel means no selection will be chosen.
Encapsulating - Drop down the list to choose the type
provided by ISP.
VPI - Type in the value provided by ISP.
VCI - Type in the value provided by ISP.
Modulation –Default setting is Multimode. Choose the one
that fits the requirement of your router.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through ARP Detect or Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose ARP Detect or Ping Detect for the system to
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
Enable/Disable Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
ISP Access Setup Enter your allocated username, password and authentication
parameters according to the information provided by your
ISP.
Service Name (Optional) - Enter the description of the
specific network service.
Username – Type in the username provided by ISP in this
field.
The maximum length of the user name you can set is 63
characters.
Password – Type in the password provided by ISP in this field.
The maximum length of the password you can set is 62
characters.
Index (1-15) in Schedule Setup - You can type in four sets of
time schedule for your request. All the schedules can be set
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
Enable / Disable Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
Keep WAN Connection Normally, this function is designed for Dynamic IP
environments because some ISPs will drop connections if
there is no traffic within certain periods of time. Check
Enable PING to keep alive box to activate this function.
PING to the IP - If you enable the PING function, please
specify the IP address for the system to PING it for keeping
alive.
PING Interval - Enter the interval for the system to execute
the PING operation.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through ARP Detect or Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose ARP Detect, Ping Detect or Always On for
the system to execute for WAN detection. If you choose Ping
Detect as the detection mode, you have to type required
settings for the following items.
Primary/Secondary Ping IP – If you choose Ping Detect as
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
PPTP/L2TP Enable PPTP- Click this radio button to enable a PPTP client
to establish a tunnel to a DSL modem on the WAN interface.
Enable L2TP - Click this radio button to enable a L2TP client
to establish a tunnel to a DSL modem on the WAN interface.
Disable – Click this radio button to close the connection
through PPTP or L2TP.
Server Address - Specify the IP address of the PPTP/L2TP
server if you enable PPTP/L2TP client mode.
Specify Gateway IP Address – Specify the gateway IP address
for DHCP server.
ISP Access Setup Username -Type in the username provided by ISP in this
field. The maximum length of the user name you can set is 63
characters.
Password -Type in the password provided by ISP in this field.
The maximum length of the password you can set is 62
characters.
Index (1-15) in Schedule Setup - You can type in four sets of
time schedule for your request. All the schedules can be set
previously in Application >> Schedule web page and you can
use the number that you have set in that web page.
MTU It means Max Transmit Unit for packet.
Path MTU Discovery – It is used to detect the maximum MTU
size of a packet not to be segmented in specific transmit
path.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
Enable/Disable Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
Obtain an IP address Click this radio button to obtain the IP address automatically
automatically if you want to use Dynamic IP mode.
Specify an IP address Click this radio button to specify dome data if you want to
use Static IP mode.
IP address - Type the IP address.
Subnet Mask - Type the subnet mask.
Gateway IP Address - Type the gateway IP address.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through ARP Detect or Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose ARP Detect, Ping Detect or Always On for
the system to execute for WAN detection. If you choose Ping
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
Modem Support List It lists all of the modems supported by such router.
3G /4G USB Modem (PPP Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
mode) this function will be closed and all the settings that you
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
II-1-2-10 Details Page for 3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP mode) in WAN3/WAN4
To use 3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP mode) as the accessing protocol of the internet, please
choose Internet Access from WAN menu. Then, select 3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP mode) for
WAN3/WAN4. The following web page will be shown.
Item Description
Modem Support List It lists all of the modems supported by such router.
3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
mode) this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
SIM PIN code Type PIN code of the SIM card that will be used to access
Internet.
The maximum length of the PIN code you can set is 19
characters.
Network Mode Force Vigor router to connect Internet with the mode
specified here. If you choose 4G/3G/2G as network mode,
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
3G/4G USB Modem (DHCP Click Enable for activating this function. If you click Disable,
mode) this function will be closed and all the settings that you
adjusted in this page will be invalid.
SIM PIN code Type PIN code of the SIM card that will be used to access
Internet.
The maximum length of the PIN code you can set is 19
characters.
Network Mode Force Vigor router to connect Internet with the mode
specified here. If you choose 4G/3G/2G as network mode,
the router will choose a suitable one according to the actual
wireless signal automatically.
APN Name APN means Access Point Name which is provided and
required by some ISPs. Type the name and click Apply.
The maximum length of the name you can set is 47
characters.
UserName Type the username (optional). The maximum length of the
name you can set is 63 characters.
Password Type the password (optional). The maximum length of the
password you can set is 62 characters.
Authentication Select None or PAP or CHAP.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to activate them.
Item Description
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose Always On or Ping Detect for the system to
execute for WAN detection. Always On means no detection
will be executed. The network connection will be on always.
Ping IP/Hostname – If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type IP address in this field
for pinging.
TTL (Time to Live) –If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type TTL value.
Below shows an example for successful IPv6 connection based on PPP mode.
Item Description
Username Type the name obtained from the broker. It is suggested for
you to apply another username and password for
http://gogonet.gogo6.com/page/freenet6-account.
The maximum length of the name you can set is 63
characters.
Password Type the password assigned with the user name.
The maximum length of the name you can set is 19
characters.
Tunnel Broker Type the address for the tunnel broker IP, FQDN or an
optional port number.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose Always On or Ping Detect for the system to
execute for WAN detection. Always On means no detection
will be executed. The network connection will be on always.
Ping IP/Hostname – If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type IP address in this field
for pinging.
TTL (Time to Live) –If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type TTL value.
Item Description
Always On Check this box to keep the network connection always.
Username Type the name obtained from the broker. Please apply new
account at http://www.sixxs.net/. It is suggested for you to
apply another username and password.
The maximum length of the name you can set is 19
characters.
Password Type the password assigned with the user name.
The maximum length of the password you can set is 19
characters.
Tunnel Broker It means a server of AICCU. The server can provide IPv6
tunnels to sites or end users over IPv4.
Type the address for the tunnel broker IP, FQDN or an
optional port number.
Tunnel ID One user account may have several tunnels. And, each
tunnel shall have one specified tunnel ID (e.g., T115394).
Type the ID offered by Tunnel Broker.
Subnet Prefix Type the subnet prefix address obtained from service
provider.
The maximum length of the prefix you can set is 128
characters.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose Always On or Ping Detect for the system to
Item Description
Identify Association Choose Prefix Delegation or Non-temporary Address as
the identify association.
IAID Type a number as IAID.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through NS Detect or Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose Always On, Ping Detect or NS Detect for
the system to execute for WAN detection. With NS Detect
mode, the system will check if network connection is
established or not, like IPv4 ARP Detect. Always On means
no detection will be executed. The network connection will
be on always.
Ping IP/Hostname – If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type IP address in this field
for pinging.
TTL (Time to Live) –If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type TTL value.
Bridge Mode Enable Bridge Mode - If the function is enabled, the router
will work as a bridge modem.
Enable Firewall – It is available when Bridge Mode is
enabled. When both Bridge Mode and Firewall check boxes
are enabled, the settings configured (user profiles) under
User Management will be ignored. And all of the filter rules
defined and enabled in Firewall menu will be activated.
Bridge Subnet – Make a bridge between the selected LAN
Item Description
Static IPv6 Address IPv6 Address – Type the IPv6 Static IP Address.
configuration Prefix Length – Type the fixed value for prefix length.
Add – Click it to add a new entry.
Delete – Click it to remove an existed entry.
Current IPv6 Address Display current interface IPv6 address.
Table
Static IPv6 Gateway IPv6 Gateway Address - Type your IPv6 gateway address
Configuration here.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Item Description
Remote Endpoint IPv4 Type the static IPv4 address for the remote server.
Address
6in4 IPv6 Address Type the static IPv6 address for IPv4 tunnel with the value
for prefix length.
LAN Routed Prefix Type the static IPv6 address for LAN routing with the value
for prefix length.
Tunnel TTL Type the number for the data lifetime in tunnel.
WAN Connection Such function allows you to verify whether network
Detection connection is alive or not through Ping Detect.
Mode – Choose Always On or Ping Detect for the system to
execute for WAN detection. Always On means no detection
will be executed. The network connection will be on
always.
Ping IP/Hostname – If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type IP address in this field
for pinging.
TTL (Time to Live) –If you choose Ping Detect as
detection mode, you have to type TTL value.
Item Description
6rd Mode Auto 6rd – Retrieve 6rd prefix automatically from 6rd
service provider. The IPv4 WAN must be set as "DHCP".
Static 6rd - Set 6rd options manually.
General
The system allows you to set up to eight channels which are ready for choosing as the first
PVC line that will be used as multi-PVC.
Item Description
Channel Display the number of each channel.
Channels 1 and 2 are used by the Internet Access web user
interface and can not be configured here.
Channels 5 ~ 10 are configurable.
Enable Display whether the settings in this channel are enabled
(Yes) or not (No).
WAN Type Displays the physical medium that the channel will use.
VPI/VCI Display the value for VPI and VCI.
VLAN Tag Displays the VLAN tag value that will be used for the packets
traveling on this channel.
Port-based Bridge The network traffic flowing on each channel will be
identified by the system via their VLAN Tags. Channels using
the same WAN type may not configure the same VLAN tag
value.
Enable - Check this box to enable the port-based bridge
function on this channel.
P1 ~ P6 – Check the box(es) to build bridge connection on
LAN.
Item Description
Multi-VLAN Channel Enable – Click it to enable the configuration of this channel.
8/9/10 Disable –Click it to disable the configuration of this channel.
WAN Type The connections and interfaces created in every channel may
select a specific WAN type to be built upon. In the Multi-PVC
application, only the Ethernet WAN type is available. The
user will be able to select the physical WAN interface the
channel shall use here.
Item Description
Multi-VLAN Channel 5/6/7 Enable – Click it to enable the configuration of this channel.
Disable –Click it to disable the configuration of this channel.
WAN Type The connections and interfaces created in every channel may
select a specific WAN type to be built upon. In the Multi-PVC
application, only the Ethernet WAN type is available. The
user will be able to select the physical WAN interface the
channel shall use here.
After finished the above settings, click OK to save the settings and return to previous page.
Item Description
QoS Type Select a proper QoS type for the channel according to the
information that your ISP provides.
PCR It represents Peak Cell Rate. The default setting is “0”.
SCR It represents Sustainable Cell Rate. The value of SCR must be
smaller than PCR.
MBS It represents Maximum Burst Size. The range of the value is
10 to 50.
PVC to PVC Binding It allows the enabled PVC channel to use the same ADSL
connection settings of another PVC channel. Please choose
the PVC channel via the drop down list.
Item Description
Enable Check the box to enable such function.
Quota Limit Type the data traffic quota allowed for such WAN interface.
There are two unit (MB and GB) offered for you to specify.
When quota exceeded Check the box(es) as the condition(s) for the system to
perform when the traffic has exceeded the budget limit.
Shutdown WAN interface – All the outgoing traffic through
such WAN interface will be terminated.
Using Notification Object – The system will send out a
notification based on the content of the notification
If the WAN budget is exhausted, a lock will be displayed on the page if Shutdown WAN
interface is selected. Which means no data transmission will be carried out. Moreover, the
system will send out a warning message to the administrator if Mail Alert is selected. Or, the
system will send out SMS message to the administrator if SMS message is selected.
Info For the IPv6 service, you have to configure WAN/LAN settings before using
the service.
2. In the following figure, use the drop down list to choose a proper connection type.
Different connection types will bring out different configuration page. Refer to the
following:
PPP – Dual Stack application, IPv4 and IPv6 services can be utilized at the same time
Choose PPP and type the information for PPPoE of IPv4.
Access into the setting page for IPv6 service, it is not necessary for you to configure
anything.
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, you will get the IP
address for IPv4 and IPv6 at the same time.
Info While using such mode, you have to make sure the IPv4 network
connection is normal.
(In the following figure, the TSPC information is obtained from http://gogo6.com/ after
applied for the service.)
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, the physical connection
will be shown as follows:
Info While using such mode, you have to make sure the IPv4 network
connection is normal.
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, the physical connection
will be shows as follows:
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, the physical connection
will be shows as follows:
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, the physical connection
will be shows as follows:
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, the physical connection
will be shows as follows:
Click OK and open Online Status. If the connection is successful, the physical connection
will be shows as follows:
2. In the field of RADVD Configuration, the default setting is Enable. The client’s PC will
ask RADVD service for the Prefix of IPv6 address automatically, and generate an
Interface ID by itself to compose a full and unique IPv6 address.
3. In the field of DHCPv6 Server Configuration, when DHCPv6 service is enabled, you can
assign available IPv6 address for the client manually.
Info When both mechanisms are enabled, the client can determine which
mechanism to be used (e.g., the default mechanism for Windows7 is
RADVD).
From the above figure we can see IPv6 IP address has been captured by the system.
2. Use the Ping command to ping any IPv6 address indicating an IPv6 website. For example,
www.kame.net is a website supporting IPv4 IP and IPv6 IP services. Its IPv6 address is
seen with a format of 2001:200:dff:fff1:216:3eff:feb1:44d7.
After getting the above message, it means the IPv6 service has been activated
successfully.
If you can see a turtle dancing on the screen, that means IPv6 service is ready for you to
access and utilize.
Local Area Network (LAN) is a group of subnets regulated and ruled by router. The design of
network structure is related to what type of public IP addresses coming from your ISP.
The most generic function of Vigor router is NAT. It creates a private subnet of your own. As
mentioned previously, the router will talk to other public hosts on the Internet by using public
IP address and talking to local hosts by using its private IP address. What NAT does is to
translate the packets from public IP address to private IP address to forward the right packets
to the right host and vice versa. Besides, Vigor router has a built-in DHCP server that assigns
private IP address to each local host. See the following diagram for a briefly understanding.
In some special case, you may have a public IP subnet from your ISP such as 220.135.240.0/24.
This means that you can set up a public subnet or call second subnet that each host is
equipped with a public IP address. As a part of the public subnet, the Vigor router will serve
for IP routing to help hosts in the public subnet to communicate with other public hosts or
servers outside. Therefore, the router should be set as the gateway for public hosts.
Item Description
General Setup Allow to configure settings for each subnet respectively.
Index - Display all of the LAN items.
Status- Basically, LAN1 status is enabled in default.
LAN2 –LAN6 and IP Routed Subnet can be observed by
checking the box of Status.
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Network Configuration For NAT Usage,
IP Address - Type in private IP address for connecting to a
local private network (Default: 192.168.1.1).
Subnet Mask - Type in an address code that determines the
size of the network. (Default: 255.255.255.0/ 24)
RIP Protocol Control,
Disable - deactivate the RIP protocol. It will lead to a
stoppage of the exchange of routing information between
routers. (Default)
Enable – activate the RIP protocol.
DHCP Server DHCP stands for Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. The
Configuration router by factory default acts a DHCP server for your network
so it automatically dispatches related IP settings to any local
user configured as a DHCP client. It is highly recommended
that you leave the router enabled as a DHCP server if you do
not have a DHCP server for your network.
If you want to use another DHCP server in the network other
than the Vigor Router’s, you can let Relay Agent help you to
redirect the DHCP request to the specified location.
Enable Server - Let the router assign IP address to every host
in the LAN.
Disable Server – Let you manually assign IP address to every
host in the LAN.
Enable Relay Agent –Specify which subnet that DHCP server
is located the relay agent should redirect the DHCP request
to.
DHCP Server IP Address – It is available when Enable
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Network Configuration Enable/Disable - Click Enable to enable such configuration;
click Disable to disable such configuration.
For NAT Usage - Click this radio button to invoke NAT
function.
For Routing Usage - Click this radio button to invoke this
function.
IP Address - Type in private IP address for connecting to a
local private network (Default: 192.168.1.1).
Subnet Mask - Type in an address code that determines the
size of the network. (Default: 255.255.255.0/ 24)
DHCP Server DHCP stands for Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. The
Configuration router by factory default acts a DHCP server for your network
so it automatically dispatch related IP settings to any local
user configured as a DHCP client. It is highly recommended
that you leave the router enabled as a DHCP server if you do
not have a DHCP server for your network.
Enable Server - Let the router assign IP address to every host
in the LAN.
Disable Server – Let you manually assign IP address to every
host in the LAN.
Enable Relay Agent - If you want to use another DHCP server
in the network other than the Vigor Router’s, you can let
Relay Agent help you to redirect the DHCP request to the
specified location.
DHCP Server IP Address – It is available when Enable Relay
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Network Configuration Enable/Disable - Click Enable to enable such configuration;
click Disable to disable such configuration.
For Routing Usage,
IP Address - Type in private IP address for connecting to a
local private network (Default: 192.168.1.1).
Subnet Mask - Type in an address code that determines the
size of the network. (Default: 255.255.255.0/ 24)
RIP Protocol Control,
Disable - deactivate the RIP protocol. It will lead to a
stoppage of the exchange of routing information between
routers. (Default)
Enable – activate the RIP protocol.
DHCP Server DHCP stands for Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol. The
Configuration router by factory default acts a DHCP server for your network
so it automatically dispatch related IP settings to any local
user configured as a DHCP client. It is highly recommended
that you leave the router enabled as a DHCP server if you do
not have a DHCP server for your network.
If you want to use another DHCP server in the network other
than the Vigor Router’s, you can let Relay Agent help you to
redirect the DHCP request to the specified location.
Start IP Address - Enter a value of the IP address pool for the
DHCP server to start with when issuing IP addresses. If the
1st IP address of your router is 192.168.1.1, the starting IP
address must be 192.168.1.2 or greater, but smaller than
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Enable Check the box to enable the configuration of LAN 1 IPv6
Setup.
WAN Primary Interface Use the drop down list to specify a WAN interface for IPv6.
Static IPv6 Address IPv6 Address –Type static IPv6 address for LAN.
configuration Prefix Length – Type the fixed value for prefix length.
Add – Click it to add a new entry.
Delete – Click it to remove an existed entry.
Unique Local Address Such feature is used for the host without assigned IPv6
(ULA) configuration address to obtain IPv6 address automatically or have an IPv6
address specified manually via ULA configuration. It is
convenient for communication among different subnets.
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Tagged VLAN
The tagged VLANs (802.1q) can mark data with a VLAN identifier. This identifier can be
carried through an onward Ethernet switch to specific ports. The specific VLAN clients can
also pick up this identifier as it is just passed to the LAN. You can set the priorities for
LAN-side QoS. You can assign each of VLANs to each of the different IP subnets that the router
may also be operating, to provide even more isolation. The said functionality is tag-based
multi-subnet.
Port-Based VLAN
Relative to tag-based VLAN which groups clients with an identifier, port-based VLAN uses
physical ports (P1 ~ P6) to separate the clients into different VLAN group.
Virtual LAN function provides you a very convenient way to manage hosts by grouping them
based on the physical port. The multi-subnet can let a small businesses have much better
isolation for multi-occupancy applications. Go to LAN page and select VLAN. The following
page will appear. Click Enable to invoke VLAN function.
Below is an example page in Vigor2860n:
Info Settings in this page only applied to LAN port but not WAN port.
Item Description
Enable Click it to enable VLAN configuration.
Wireless LAN (2.4GHz) SSID1 – SSID4 – Check the SSID boxes to group them under the
selected VLAN.
Wireless LAN (5GHz) SSID1 – SSID4 – Check the SSID boxes to group them under the
selected VLAN.
Info Leave one VLAN untagged at least to prevent from not connecting to Vigor
router due to unexpected error.
Vigor2860 series features a hugely flexible VLAN system. In its simplest form, each of the
Gigabit LAN ports can be isolated from each other, for example to feed different companies
or departments but keeping their local traffic completely separated.
4. Click OK.
Vigor router supports up to six private IP subnets on LAN. Each can be independent
(isolated) or common (able to communicate with each other). This is ideal for
departmental or multi-occupancy applications.
Item Description
Enable Click this radio button to invoke this function. However,
IP/MAC which is not listed in IP Bind List also can connect to
Internet.
Disable Click this radio button to disable this function. All the
settings on this page will be invalid.
Strict Bind Click this radio button to block the connection of the IP/MAC
which is not listed in IP Bind List.
ARP Table This table is the LAN ARP table of this router. The
information for IP and MAC will be displayed in this field.
Each pair of IP and MAC address listed in ARP table can be
selected and added to IP Bind List by clicking Add below.
Select All Click this link to select all the items in the ARP table.
Sort Reorder the table based on the IP address.
Info Before you select Strict Bind, you have to bind one set of IP/MAC address for
one PC. If not, no one of the PCs can access into Internet. And the web user
interface of the router might not be accessed.
Item Description
Port Mirror Check Enable to activate this function. Or, check Disable to
close this function.
Mirror Port Select a port to view traffic sent from mirrored ports.
Mirrored Tx Port Select which ports are necessary to be mirrored for
transmitting the packets.
Mirrored Rx Port Select which ports are necessary to be mirrored for receiving
the packets.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Hardware Acceleration is also called PPA in DrayTek for it is based on Protocol Processing
Engine (PPE) of Infineon. It can only support 128 sessions for network traffic (IN & OUT) with
implementing three kinds of modes - Disable, Auto and Manual.
II-3-1 Setup
When the data traffic is heavy and data transmission is getting slowly and slowly, you can
configure this page to accelerate the data streaming by hardware itself. Open Hardware
Acceleration to access into the following page:
Item Description
Mode Disable – The default setting.
Auto - When the hardware acceleration is configured with
the Auto mode, the sessions with the heaviest loading and
the lower latency traffic will be added into PPA. However,
the Auto mode does not support UDP protocol by designed.
Manual - The Manual mode implements three sub-items--
Accelerate most heavy traffic sessions, Apply the Class Rule
Protocol There are two types supported by this function, TCP and
UDP.
Option Accelerate heaviest traffic sessions – Such option is
available in Auto Mode, too. But the UDP protocol is only
supported in this sub-item.
Apply the Class Rule in Quality of Service – Users can apply
the information provided by QoS in this sub-item.
Please visit our website for referring the detailed
configuration of QoS.
For checking whether the rule of PPA is working or not, a user can login to Vigor2860 series by
using telnet. User can view how many sessions are transferring in each direction of PPA table
after entering “ppa –v”.
Usually, the router serves as an NAT (Network Address Translation) router. NAT is a
mechanism that one or more private IP addresses can be mapped into a single public one.
Public IP address is usually assigned by your ISP, for which you may get charged. Private IP
addresses are recognized only among internal hosts.
When the outgoing packets destined to some public server on the Internet reach the NAT
router, the router will change its source address into the public IP address of the router,
select the available public port, and then forward it. At the same time, the router shall list an
entry in a table to memorize this address/port-mapping relationship. When the public server
response, the incoming traffic, of course, is destined to the router’s public IP address and the
router will do the inversion based on its table. Therefore, the internal host can communicate
with external host smoothly.
The benefit of the NAT includes:
Save cost on applying public IP address and apply efficient usage of IP address. NAT
allows the internal IP addresses of local hosts to be translated into one public IP address,
thus you can have only one IP address on behalf of the entire internal hosts.
Enhance security of the internal network by obscuring the IP address. There are
many attacks aiming victims based on the IP address. Since the attacker cannot be
aware of any private IP addresses, the NAT function can protect the internal network.
Info On NAT page, you will see the private IP address defined in RFC-1918.
Usually we use the 192.168.1.0/24 subnet for the router. As stated before,
the NAT facility can map one or more IP addresses and/or service ports into
different specified services. In other words, the NAT function can be
achieved by using port mapping methods.
Item Description
Index Display the number of the profile.
Service Name Display the description of the specific network service.
WAN Interface Display the WAN IP address used by the profile.
Protocol Display the transport layer protocol (TCP or UDP).
Public Port Display the port number which will be redirected to the
specified Private IP and Port of the internal host.
Private IP Display the IP address of the internal host providing the
service.
Status Display if the profile is enabled (v) or not (x).
Press any number under Index to access into next page for configuring port redirection.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Note that the router has its own built-in services (servers) such as Telnet, HTTP and FTP etc.
Since the common port numbers of these services (servers) are all the same, you may need to
reset the router in order to avoid confliction.
For example, the built-in web user interface in the router is with default port 80, which may
conflict with the web server in the local network, http://192.168.1.13:80. Therefore, you
need to change the router’s http port to any one other than the default port 80 to avoid
conflict, such as 8080. This can be set in the System Maintenance >>Management Setup. You
then will access the admin screen of by suffixing the IP address with 8080, e.g.,
http://192.168.1.1:8080 instead of port 80.
The security properties of NAT are somewhat bypassed if you set up DMZ host. We suggest
you to add additional filter rules or a secondary firewall.
Click DMZ Host to open the following page. You can set different DMZ host for each WAN
interface. Click the WAN tab to switch into the configuration page for that WAN.
Item Description
Choose Private IP or Active True IP first.
Active True IP selection is available for WAN1 only.
Private IP Enter the private IP address of the DMZ host, or click Choose
PC to select one.
Choose IP Click this button and then a window will automatically pop
up, as depicted below. The window consists of a list of private
IP addresses of all hosts in your LAN network. Select one
private IP address in the list to be the DMZ host.
When you have selected one private IP from the above dialog,
the IP address will be shown on the following screen. Click OK
to save the setting.
DMZ Host for WAN2, WAN3, LTE or WAN4 is slightly different with WAN1. Active True IP
selection is available for WAN1 only.
See the following figure.
Item Description
Enable Check to enable the DMZ Host function.
Private IP Enter the private IP address of the DMZ host, or click Choose
PC to select one.
Choose PC Click this button and then a window will automatically pop
up, as depicted below. The window consists of a list of
private IP addresses of all hosts in your LAN network. Select
one private IP address in the list to be the DMZ host.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Index Indicate the relative number for the particular entry that you
want to offer service in a local host. You should click the
appropriate index number to edit or clear the corresponding
entry.
Comment Specify the name for the defined network service.
WAN Interface Display the WAN interface used by such index.
Aux. WAN IP Display the IP alias setting used by such index. If no IP alias
setting exists, such field will not appear.
Local IP Address Display the private IP address of the local host offering the
service.
Status Display the state for the corresponding entry. X or V is to
represent the Inactive or Active state.
To add or edit port settings, click one index number on the page. The index entry setup page
will pop up. In each index entry, you can specify 10 port ranges for diverse services.
Item Description
Enable Open Ports Check to enable this entry.
Comment Make a name for the defined network application/service.
WAN Interface Specify the WAN interface that will be used for this entry.
Source IP Use the drop down list to specify an IP object. Or click IP
Object link to create a new one for applying.
WAN IP Specify the WAN IP address that will be used for this entry.
This setting is available when WAN IP Alias is configured.
Private IP Enter the private IP address of the local host or click Choose
PC to select one.
Choose IP - Click this button and, subsequently, a window
having a list of private IP addresses of local hosts will
automatically pop up. Select the appropriate IP address of
the local host in the list.
Protocol Specify the transport layer protocol. It could be TCP, UDP,
or ----- (none) for selection.
Start Port Specify the starting port number of the service offered by
the local host.
End Port Specify the ending port number of the service offered by the
local host.
Item Description
Comment Display the text which memorizes the application of this
Item Description
Enable Check to enable this entry.
Service Choose the predefined service to apply for such trigger
profile.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Dynamic DNS
The ISP often provides you with a dynamic IP address when you connect to the Internet via
your ISP. It means that the public IP address assigned to your router changes each time you
access the Internet. The Dynamic DNS feature lets you assign a domain name to a dynamic
WAN IP address. It allows the router to update its online WAN IP address mappings on the
specified Dynamic DNS server. Once the router is online, you will be able to use the registered
domain name to access the router or internal virtual servers from the Internet. It is
particularly helpful if you host a web server, FTP server, or other server behind the router.
Before you use the Dynamic DNS feature, you have to apply for free DDNS service to the DDNS
service providers. The router provides up to three accounts from three different DDNS service
providers. Basically, Vigor routers are compatible with the DDNS services supplied by most
popular DDNS service providers such as www.dyndns.org, www.no-ip.com, www.dtdns.com,
www.changeip.com, www.dynamic- nameserver.com. You should visit their websites to
register your own domain name for the router.
Schedule
The Vigor router has a built-in clock which can update itself manually or automatically by
means of Network Time Protocols (NTP). As a result, you can not only schedule the router to
dialup to the Internet at a specified time, but also restrict Internet access to certain hours so
that users can connect to the Internet only during certain hours, say, business hours. The
schedule is also applicable to other functions.
RADIUS/TACACS+
Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) is a security authentication
client/server protocol that supports authentication, authorization and accounting, which is
widely used by Internet service providers. It is the most common method of authenticating
and authorizing dial-up and tunneled network users.
The built-in RADIUS client feature enables the router to assist the remote dial-in user or a
wireless station and the RADIUS server in performing mutual authentication. It enables
centralized remote access authentication for network management.
Wake on LAN
A PC client on LAN can be woken up by the router it connects. When a user wants to wake up
a specified PC through the router, he/she must type correct MAC address of the specified PC
on this web page of Wake on LAN (WOL) of this router.
In addition, such PC must have installed a network card supporting WOL function. By the way,
WOL function must be set as “Enable” on the BIOS setting.
Item Description
Enable Dynamic DNS Check this box to enable DDNS function.
Setup
Set to Factory Clear all profiles and recover to factory settings.
Default
View Log Display DDNS log status.
Force Update Force the router updates its information to DDNS server.
Auto-Update Set the time for the router to perform auto update for DDNS
interval service.
Index Click the number below Index to access into the setting page
of DDNS setup to set account(s).
WAN Interface Display the WAN interface used.
Domain Name Display the domain name that you set on the setting page of
DDNS setup.
Active Display if this account is active or inactive.
4. Select Index number 1 to add an account for the router. Check Enable Dynamic DNS
Account, and choose correct Service Provider: dyndns.org, type the registered
hostname: hostname and domain name suffix: dyndns.org in the Domain Name block.
The following two blocks should be typed your account Login Name: test and Password:
test.
Item Description
Enable Dynamic DNS Check this box to enable the current account. If you did
Account check the box, you will see a check mark appeared on the
Active column of the previous web page in step 2).
WAN Interface WAN1/WAN2/WAN3/WAN4/LTE First - While connecting,
the router will use WAN1/WAN2/WAN3/WAN4/LTE as the
first channel for such account. If WAN1/WAN2/WAN3
/WAN4/LTE fails, the router will use another WAN interface
instead.
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3/WAN4/LTE Only - While connecting,
the router will use WAN1/WAN2/WAN3/WAN4/LTE as the
5. Click OK button to activate the settings. You will see your setting has been saved.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles and recover to factory settings.
Item Description
Enable Check this box to enable such profile.
Profile Type a name for such profile.
Note: If you type a name here for LAN DNS and click OK to
save the configuration, the name also will be applied to
conditional DNS forwarding automatically.
Domain Name Type the domain name for such profile.
IP Address List The IP address listed here will be used for mapping with the
domain name specified above. In general, one domain name
maps with one IP address. If required, you can configure two
IP addresses mapping with the same domain name.
Add – Click it to open a dialog to type the host’s IP address.
Item Description
Enable Check this box to enable such profile.
Profile Type a name for such profile.
Note: If you type a name here for conditional DNS forwarding
and click OK to save the configuration, the name also will be
applied to LAN DNS automatically.
Domain Name Type the domain name for such profile.
DNS Server IP Address Type the IP address of the DNS server you want to use for DNS
forwarding.
Item Description
Enable Check the box to enable the DNS security management.
Interface There are four WAN interfaces allowed to be set with DNS
security enabled.
Primary DNS Display the IP address of primary DNS obtained from DHCP
server or specified by Static WAN.
Secondary DNS Display the IP address of secondary DNS obtained from DHCP
server or specified by Static WAN.
Bogus DNS Reply Sometime, Vigor router might encounter packets from bogus
DNS inquiry. There are two ways to reply such DNS inquiry.
Drop – Discard the packets.
Pass – Accept the packets and let them pass through Vigor
router.
Item Description
Domain Type the domain name or IP address (IPv4/IPv6) that you
want to query.
Interface Specify the interface required for executing diagnose.
DNS Server Type the IP address of the DNS Server which will diagnose the
domain specified above.
Diagnose Click it to perform the diagnosis for the domain.
Result The diagnosed information will be displayed on such field.
Item Description
Current System Time Display the time Vigor router used.
System time set Click it to acess into the time setup page (System
Maintenance>>Time and Date).
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles and recover to factory settings.
Enable Click the box to enable such schedule profile.
You can set up to 15 schedules. Then you can apply them to your Internet Access or VPN and
Remote Access >> LAN-to-LAN settings.
To add a schedule:
1. Click any index, say Index No. 1.
2. The detailed settings of the schedule with index 1 will be shown below.
Item Description
Enable Schedule Check to enable the schedule.
Setup
Comment Type a short description for such schedule.
Start Date Specify the starting date of the schedule.
(yyyy-mm-dd)
Start Time (hh:mm) Specify the starting time of the schedule.
Duration Time Specify the duration (or period) for the schedule.
(hh:mm)
End Time (hh:mm) It will be calculated automatically when Start Time and
Duration Time are configured well.
Action Specify which action Call Schedule should apply during the
period of the schedule.
Force On -Force the connection to be always on.
Force Down -Force the connection to be always down.
Example
Suppose you want to control the PPPoE Internet access connection to be always on (Force On)
from 9:00 to 18:00 for whole week. Other time the Internet access connection should be
disconnected (Force Down).
Office
Hour:
(Force On)
1. Make sure the PPPoE connection and Time Setup is working properly.
2. Configure the PPPoE always on from 9:00 to 18:00 for whole week.
3. Configure the Force Down from 18:00 to next day 9:00 for whole week.
4. Assign these two profiles to the PPPoE Internet access profile. Now, the PPPoE Internet
connection will follow the schedule order to perform Force On or Force Down action
according to the time plan that has been pre-defined in the schedule profiles.
II-5-5 RADIUS/TACACS+
Remote Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) is a security authentication
client/server protocol that supports authentication, authorization and accounting, which is
widely used by Internet service providers. It is the most common method of authenticating
and authorizing dial-up and tunneled network users.
Item Description
Enable Check to enable RADIUS client feature.
Server IP Address Enter the IP address of RADIUS server
Destination Port The UDP port number that the RADIUS server is using. The
default value is 1812, based on RFC 2138.
Shared Secret The RADIUS server and client share a secret that is used to
authenticate the messages sent between them. Both sides
must be configured to use the same shared secret. The
maximum length of the shared secret you can set is 36
characters.
Confirm Shared Secret Re-type the Shared Secret for confirmation.
After finished the above settings, click OK button to save the settings.
Item Description
Enable Check to enable internal RADIUS client feature.
Authentication Port Set a port number for internal RADIUS server.
RADIUS Client Access List Allow to configure that clients under specified domain (IPv4
and IPv6) must be authenticated with the specified shared
secret.
Enable - Check to enable RADIUS client feature.
Shared Secret - The RADIUS server and client share a secret
that is used to authenticate the messages sent between
them. Both sides must be configured to use the same shared
secret. The maximum length of the shared secret you can set
is 36 characters.
IP Address – Type the IP addres of the wired/wireless
client.
IP Mask – Type the subnet mask required for the IP address.
IPv6 Address – Type the IPv6 address of the wired/wireless
client.
IPv6 Length - Type the prefix length required for the IPv6
After finished the above settings, click OK button to save the settings.
Item Description
Enable Check to enable TACACS+ feature.
After finished the above settings, click OK button to save the settings.
Item Description
Enable Check to enable such function.
Bind Type There are three types of bind type supported.
Simple Mode – Just simply do the bind authentication
without any search action.
Anonymous – Perform a search action first with
Anonymous account then do the bind authentication.
Regular Mode– Mostly it is the same with anonymous
mode. The different is that, the server will firstly check
if you have the search authority.
For the regular mode, you’ll need to type in the Regular DN
After finished the above settings, click OK button to save the settings.
II-5-6-2 Profiles
You can configure eight AD/LDAP profiles. These profiles would be used with User
Management for different purposes in management.
Item Description
Name Type a name for such profile. The length of the user name is
limited to 19 characters.
Common Name Identifier Type or edit the common name identifier for the LDAP server.
The common name identifier for most LDAP server is “cn”.
Base Distinguished Name Type or edit the distinguished name used to look up entries on
/ Group Distinguished the LDAP server.
Name
Sometimes, you may forget the Distinguished Name since it’s
too long. Then you may click the button to list all the
account information on the AD/LDAP Server to assist you finish
the setup.
After finished the above settings, click OK to save and exit this page. A new profile has been
created.
Info UPnP is required for some applications such as PPS, Skype, eMule...and etc.
If you are not familiar with UPnP, it is suggested to turn off this function for
security.
Item Description
Enable UPNP Service Accordingly, you can enable either the Connection Control
Service or Connection Status Service.
Default WAN It is used to specify the WAN interface for applying such
function.
Item Description
IGMP Proxy Check this box to enable this function. The application of
multicast will be executed through WAN/LTE/PVC/VLAN
port. In addition, such function is available in NAT mode.
IGMP Snooping Check this box to enable this function. Multicast traffic will
be forwarded to ports that have members of that group.
Disabling IGMP snooping will make multicast traffic treated
in the same manner as broadcast traffic.
Refresh Click this link to renew the working multicast group status.
Group ID This field displays the ID port for the multicast group. The
available range for IGMP starts from 224.0.0.0 to
239.255.255.254.
P1 to P6 It indicates the LAN port used for the multicast group.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Wake by Two types provide for you to wake up the binded IP.
If you choose Wake by MAC Address, you have to type
the correct MAC address of the host in MAC Address
boxes.
If you choose Wake by IP Address, you have to choose
the correct IP address.
IP Address The IP addresses that have been configured in
Firewall>>Bind IP to MAC will be shown in this drop down
list. Choose the IP address from the drop down list that you
want to wake up.
MAC Address Type any one of the MAC address of the bound PCs.
Wake Up Click this button to wake up the selected IP. See the
following figure. The result will be shown on the box.
Item Description
Index Check the box to enable such profile.
SMS Provider Use the drop down list to choose SMS service provider.
You can click SMS Provider link to define the SMS server.
Recipient Type the name of the one who will receive the SMS.
Notify Profile Use the drop down list to choose a message profile. The
recipient will get the content stated in the message profile.
You can click the Notify Profile link to define the content
of the SMS.
Schedule (1-15) Type the schedule number that the SMS will be sent out.
You can click the Schedule(1-15) link to define the
schedule.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Index Check the box to enable such profile.
Mail Service Use the drop down list to choose mail service object. All of
the available objects are created in Object
Settings>>SMS/Mail Service Object. If there is no object
listed, click Mail Service link to define a new one with
specified service provider.
Recipient Type the e-mail address of the one who will receive the
notification message.
Notify Profile Use the drop down list to choose a message profile. The
recipient will get the content stated in the message profile.
You can click the Notify Profile link to define the content
of the mail message.
Schedule (1-15) Type the schedule number that the notification will be sent
out.
You can click the Schedule(1-15) link to define the
schedule.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Below shows an example for applying the bonjour feature that Vigor router can be used as the
FTP server.
1. Here, we use Firefox and DNSSD to discover the service in such case. Therefore, just
ensure the Bonjour client program and DNSSD for Firefox have been installed on the
computer.
3. Open System Maintenance>>Management. Type a name as the Router Name and click
OK.
4. Next, open Applications>>Bonjour. Check the service that you want to use via Bonjour.
5. Open the DNSSD page again. The available items will be changed as the follows. It means
the Vigor router (based on Bonjour protocol) is ready to be used as a printer server, FTP
server, SSH Server, Telnet Server, and HTTP Server.
Item Description
Enable High Abailablity Check this box to enable HA function.
Redundancy Method Choose Hot-Standby or Active-Standby as the method for HA.
Hot-Standby -
Such method is suitable for a user which has one ISP account.
With such method;
All WANs of secondary routers will be shut down by HA
function.
WAN settings of primary and secondary routers can be
the same.
Note: When Hot-Standby is used, wireless LAN will be
“enabled” automatically for clients connecting to the
primary router; however, wireless LAN on secondary
router will be “disabled” directlly. Thus clients can
not connect to the secondary router any more.
Active-Standby -
Item Description
Group ID Type a value (1~255).
In LAN environment, multiple routers can be devided into
several groups. Each router must be specified with one group
ID. Different routers with the same ID value will be
categoried into the same group.
Only one of the routers in the same group will be selected as
the primary router.
Priority ID Type a value (1~30).
Different routers must be configured with different IDs.
The router with the highest priority will be treated as
primary router. If multiple routers have the same priority,
the router with lower “IP” will be treated as primary. “IP” is
the IP address configured on LAN >> General Setup page, in
which LAN is determined by management interface.
Authentication Key Type a string as the authentication key (maximum 31
characters allowed).
It is used for encrypting the DARP to prevent malicious
attack.
Protocol Choose IPv4 or IPv6.
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Enable Config Sync (Max. Check this box to enable configuration synchronization.
Sync to 10 routers) To sync configuration from primary to secondary router,
both primary and seconday routers need to enable “config
sync”. Note that config sync can be enabled by Hot-Standby
redundancy method only.
Config Sync Interval Day / Hour / Minute - Primary router will sync its
configuration to secondary router based on the time interval
set here.
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Enable Click it to enable local 802.1X server.
At present, such feature can be used for wireless and wired
802.1x authentication.
User Profile Select All – Click it to select all of the profiles under
Available List.
Clear All – Click it to remove all of the profiles under
Authentication List.
Sync User Profile …. Make the enabling/disabling setting for both Internal RADIUS
and Local 802.1X synchronize for all of the user profiles
(User Management>>User Profile).
For example, if Local 802.1x is configured as Enabled
(checked), the Internal RADIUS will be configured as Enabled
too.
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
After above configurations, users belong to either “rd1” or “shrd” group can access Internet
after inputting their credentials on LDAP server.
This article describes how to configure customized DDNS on Vigor routers to update your IP to
the DDNS server. We will take “Changeip.org” and “3322.net” as example. Before setting,
please make sure that the WAN connection is up.
Part A : Changeip.org
Note that,
Username: jo***
Password: jo********
Host name: j*****.changeip.org
WAN IP address: 1.169.185.242
Following is the screenshot of editing the HTML script on the browser to update your IP to the
DDNS server.
1. Please go to Applications >> Dynamic DNS to create a profile for Customized DDNS
client.
In which, ###IP### is a value which will be replaced with the current interface IP
address automatically when DDNS service is running. In this case the IP will be
1.169.185.242.
4. After setting, the Customized DDNS service will be up, and our IP will be updated to the
DDNS server.
Part B : 3322.net
Username: bi*******
Password: 88********
Host name: bi*******.3322.org
To update the IP to the DDNS server via editing the HTML script, we can type the following
script on the browser:
“good 111.243.178.53” means our IP has been updated to the server successfully.
Now we have to configure the router so it can do the same job for us automatically.
1. Please go to Applications >> Dynamic DNS to create a profile for Customized DDNS
client.
6. After the setting, the Customized DDNS service will be up, and our IP will be updated to
the DDNS server automatically.
Route Policy (also well known as PBR, policy-based routing) is a feature where you may need
to get a strategy for routing. The packets will be directed to the specified interface if they
match one of the policies. You can setup route policies in various reasons such as load balance,
security, routing decision, and etc.
Through protocol, IP address, port number and interface configuration, Route Policy can be
used to configure any routing rules to fit actual request. In general, Route Policy can easily
reach the following purposes:
Load Balance
You may manually create policies to balance the traffic across network interface.
Specify Interface
Through dedicated interface (WAN/LAN/VPN), the data can be sent from the source IP to the
destination IP.
Address Mapping
Allows you specify the outgoing WAN IP address (es) for an internal private IP address or a
range of internal private IP addresses.
Priority
The router will determine which policy will be adopted for transmitting the packet according
to the priority of Static Route and Route Policy.
Failover to/Failback
Packets will be sent through another Interface or follow another Policy when the original
interface goes down (Failover to). Once the original interface resumes service (Failback),
the packets will be returned to it immediately.
Other routing
Specify routing policy to determine the direction of the data transmission.
Info For more detailed information about using policy route, refer to Support
>>FAQ/Application Notes on www.draytek.com.
Item Description
Index The number (1 to 30) under Index allows you to open next
page to set up static route.
Destination Address Displays the destination address of the static route.
Status Displays the status of the static route.
Set to Factory Default Clear all of the settings and return to factory default
settings.
Viewing Routing Table Displays the routing table for your reference.
1. Go to LAN page and click General Setup, select 1st Subnet as the RIP Protocol Control.
Then click the OK button.
Info There are two reasons that we have to apply RIP Protocol Control on
1st Subnet. The first is that the LAN interface can exchange RIP
packets with the neighboring routers via the 1st subnet
(192.168.1.0/24). The second is that those hosts on the internal
private subnets (ex. 192.168.10.0/24) can access the Internet via the
router, and continuously exchange of IP routing information with
different subnets.
Item Description
Enable Click it to enable this profile.
Destination IP Type an IP address as the destination of such static route.
Address
Subnet Mask Type the subnet mask for such static route.
Network Interface Use the drop down list to specify an interface for such
static route.
3. Return to Static Route Setup page. Click on another Index Number to add another
static route as show below, which regulates all packets destined to 211.100.88.0 will be
forwarded to 192.168.1.3. Click OK.
Item Description
Index The number (1 to 40) under Index allows you to open next
page to set up static route.
Destination Address Displays the destination address of the static route.
Status Displays the status of the static route.
Set to Factory Default Clear all of the settings and return to factory default
settings.
Viewing IPv6 Routing Displays the routing table for your reference.
Table
Item Description
Enable Click it to enable this profile.
Destination IPv6 Address / Type the IP address with the prefix length for this entry.
Prefix Len
Gateway IPv6 Address Type the gateway address for this entry.
When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Index Click the number of index to access into the configuration
web page.
Enable Check this box to enable this policy.
Protocol Display the protocol used for this policy.
Interface Display the interface to send packets to once the policy is
matched.
Priority Display the priority value for such route policy profile.
Src IP Start Display the IP address for the start of the source IP.
Src IP End Display the IP address for the end of the source IP.
Dest IP Start Display the IP address for the start of the destination IP.
Dest IP End Display the IP address for the end of the destination IP.
Dest Port Start Display the IP address for the start of the destination port.
Dest Port End Display the IP address for the end of the destination port.
Move UP/Move Down Use Up or Down link to move the order of the policy.
Wizard Mode Allow to configure frequently used settings of route policy
via three setting pages
Advance Mode Allow to configure detailed settings of route policy.
Item Description
Source IP Any – Any IP can be treated as the source IP.
Src IP Start - Type the source IP start for the specified WAN
interface.
Src IP End - Type the source IP end for the specified WAN
interface. If this field is blank, it means that all the source
IPs inside the LAN will be passed through the WAN
interface.
Destination IP Any – Any IP can be treated as the destination IP.
Dest IP Start- Type the destination IP start for the specified
WAN interface.
Dest IP End - Type the destination IP end for the specified
WAN interface. If this field is blank, it means that all the
destination IPs will be passed through the WAN interface.
Item Description
Interface Use the drop down list to choose a WAN or LAN interface or
VPN profile. Packets match with the above criteria will be
transferred to the interface chosen here.
Item Description
Force NAT /Force It determines which mechanism that the router will use to
Routing forward the packet to WAN.
5. After choosing the mechanism, click Next to get the summary page for reference.
Item Description
Enable Check this box to enable this policy.
Protocol Use the drop-down menu to choose a proper protocol for
the WAN interface.
3. When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
II-6-2-2 Diagnose
With the analysis done by such page, possible path (static route, routing table or policy
route) of the packets sent out of the router can be traced.
or
Item Description
Mode Analyze how a packet will be sent – Choose such mode to
make Vigor router analyze how a single packet will be sent
by a route policy.
Analyze how multiple packets… - Choose such mode to
make Vigor router analyze how multiple packets in a
specified file will be sent by a route policy.
Packet Information Specify the nature of the packets to be analyzed by Vigor
router.
ICMP/UDP/TCP/ANY- Specify a protocol for diagnosis.
Src IP – Type an IP address as the source IP.
Dst IP – Type an IP address as the destination IP.
Dst Port – Use the drop down list to specify the destination
port.
Analyze – Click it to perform the job of analyzing. The
analyzed result will be shown on the page. If required, click
export analysis to export the result as a file.
Input File Select – Click the download link to get a blank example
file. Then, click such button to select that blank “.csv” file
for saving the result of analysis.
A-1 How to Customize a Secure Route between VPN Router and Remote
Router by Using Route Policy
Example 1:
In the following figure, a LAN to LAN VPN tunnel is built between DrayTek VPN router (e.g.,
Vigor2860 series) and the remote router. Firewall Router can receive all of the traffic coming
from remote PC which wants to access into Internet; and send back the packets to Remote
Router through VPN Router.
1. Establish a VPN tunnel between VPN Router and the Remote Router.
2. Change to default route for the router located in Remote Router.
3. Access into the web user interface of the router in VPN Router. Then, open
Load-Balance / Route Policy>>General Setup and click Advance Mode.
Now, if you want such route policy will be applied by Vigor router with higher priority,
please adjust the value of Priority for such route policy. In general, default route is
specified with the lowest priority for it value is fixed as “250”. And Routes in Routing
Table are fixed as “150”. You can adjust the value for such route policy with lower value,
e.g., 100 to ensure it will be applied to packets transmission with the highest priority.
5. After finished the above settings, click OK to save the configuration.
Click the WAN IP Alias button to configure the other IP address which is 202.211.100.11.
Make sure Join IP NAT Pool is not checked. Click OK to save the settings.
5. Click Index number 1 and 2 to configure the details. After finished the settings, click OK
to save the settings respectively.
6. Upon completing the above configuration, you have specified the outgoing IP address(es)
for some specific computers.
Now, you bind some specific computers to some WAN IP alias for outgoing traffic.
2. From the following web page, simply click index number #1.
Now, the packets sent to the remote PC (IP address: 203.65.1.35) will be forced to pass
through WAN1.
This section can guide you to use the SIM card in LTE WAN to perform SMS related operations.
Item Description
Enable SMS Quota Limit Check the box to enable such feature.
Quota Limit Specify the maximum number of sending SMS for LTE.
When quota exceeded There are two actions to be performed when the quota limit
is expired.
Stop sending SMS – If it is checked, no SMS for LTE will be
sent after the quota limit is expired.
Send Mail Alert to Administrator – If it is checkd, a mail
alert will be sent to the administrator when the quota limit is
expired.
Monthly This setting is to offer a mechanism of resetting the number
of SMS sent record every month.
SMS quota resets on day XX at XX … –You can determine the
starting day in one month. The number of SMS sent will be
reset.
Custom This setting allows the user to define the billing cycle
according to his request.
The number of SMS sent will be reset with an interval of
cycle duration.
Custom – Monthly is default setting. If long period or a short
period is required, use Custom. The period of reset is
between 1 day and 60 days. You can determine the cycle
duration by specifying the days and the hours.
Cycle duration: Specify the days to reset the number of
Item Description
Mark as Read Those messages in "unread" state are showed in bold text. If
you want to change messages into "read" state, select them
and click the OK button. Checking the checkbox in title will
select all "unread" messages in this page.
Delete If you want to delete messages, select them and click the OK
button. Checking the checkbox in title will select all
messages in this page.
Details If you want to read the full content of the message, click the
View link of that message to open the following page. It will
change the message into "read" state.
Item Description
Mark as Read Those SMS in "unread" state are shown in bold text. If you
want to change SMS into "read" state, select them and click
the OK button. Checking the checkbox in title will select all
"unread" SMS in this page.
Delete If you want to delete SMS, select them and click the OK
button. Checking the checkbox in title will select all SMS in
this page.
Index If you want to read the full content of the message of the
SMS, click the index link of that SMS to open the following
page. It will change all SMS of the message into "read" state.
Item Description
Recipient Number Type the phone number of the recipient.
The format can be an international phone number
( +8869123455678) or a general phone number(0912345678).
Data Coding Scheme The router will automatically select a suitable Data Coding
Scheme according to the current content in Message. GSM
7-bit and UCS-2 are supported.
Message Type in the message content to send.
The total number of characters that you can type in this field
is 1024.
Send Message Click it to send this SMS message to the recipient
immediately.
View SMS Outbox Cache Display the record of SMS messages sent from the Router.
Item Description
Reboot on SMS Message
Enable with Password / To reboot Vigor router remotely via SMS, please check such
PIN box and type the password/PIN number (treated as
This page will display basic information about the embedded LTE module and the current LTE
connection.
Item Description
Status LTE WAN status.
IMEI International Mobile Equipment Identity of the embedded
LTE module.
IMSI International Mobile Subscripber Identity of the LTE SIM card.
Access Tech Type of LTE connection
(CDMA/GSM/WCDMA/LTE/TD-SCDMA).
Band Band of LTE connection.
Operator ISP name of LTE connection.
Mobile Country Code / Base station information.
Mobile Network Code /
Location Area Code / Cell
ID :
Signal Signal strength of LTE connection.
Active Channel Frequency of LTE connection.
Interference with 2.4GHz Whether the current LTE frequency causes interference with
2.4G wireless. If Yes, the interfered 2.4G wireless channels
Info The actual data throughput will vary according to the network conditions
and environmental factors, including volume of network traffic, network
overhead and building materials.
In an Infrastructure Mode of wireless network, Vigor wireless router plays a role as an Access
Point (AP) connecting to lots of wireless clients or Stations (STA). All the STAs will share the
same Internet connection via Vigor wireless router. The General Settings will set up the
information of this wireless network, including its SSID as identification, located channel etc.
Multiple SSIDs
Vigor router supports four SSID settings for wireless connections. Each SSID can be defined
with different name and download/upload rate for selecting by stations connected to the
router wirelessly.
Info The password (PSK) of default security mode is provided and stated on the
label pasted on the bottom of the router. For the wireless client who wants
to access into Internet through such router, please input the default PSK
value for connection.
DFS Restrictions
WPS
WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) provides easy procedure to make network connection between
wireless station and wireless access point (vigor router) with the encryption of WPA and
WPA2.
2. The screen of wireless wizard will be shown as follows. This page will be used for internal
users in a company or your home. Besides, the settings will change based on different
model of Vigor2860 series. In this case, Vigor2860ac is used as an example.
Item Description
Wireless 2.4GHz Settings
Name Type the SSID name of this router for wireless 2.4GHz. The
default name is defined with DrayTek. Change the name if
required.
Mode At present, the router can connect to 11n Only, 11g Only,
Item Description
Wireless 2.4GHz Settings
Enable/Disable Click it to enable or disable settings in this page.
SSID Type the SSID name of this router. (SSID1)
Security Key The wireless mode offered by this wizard is WPA2/PSK.
The WPA encrypts each frame transmitted from the radio
using the key, which either PSK (Pre-Shared Key) entered
manually in this field below or automatically negotiated via
802.1x authentication.
Either 8~63 ASCII characters, such as 012345678(or 64
Hexadecimal digits leading by 0x, such as
"0x321253abcde...").
Rate Control It controls the data transmission rate through wireless
connection.
Upload – Check Enable and type the transmitting rate for
data upload. Default value is 30,000 kbps.
Download – Type the transmitting rate for data download.
Default value is 30,000 kbps.
Wireless 5GHz Settings
Enable/Disable Click it to enable or disable settings in this page.
Use the same SSID Check the box to use the same settings configured above.
and Security Key as
above
SSID Type the SSID name of this router. (SSID2)
5. The following page will display the configuration summary for wireless setting.
Item Description
Enable Wireless LAN Check the box to enable wireless function.
Mode For 2.4GHz/LTE: At present, the router can connect to 11g
Only, 11n Only(2.4 GHz), Mixed (11b+11g), Mixed (11g+11n),
and Mixed (11b+11g+11n) stations simultaneously. Simply
choose Mixed (11b+11g+11n) mode.
Hide SSID Check it to prevent from wireless sniffing and make it harder
for unauthorized clients or STAs to join your wireless LAN.
Depending on the wireless utility, the user may only see the
information except SSID or just cannot see any thing about
Vigor wireless router while site surveying. The system allows
you to set four sets of SSID for different usage. In default,
the first set of SSID will be enabled. You can hide it for your
necessity.
SSID Means the identification of the wireless LAN. SSID can be any
text numbers or various special characters.
Isolate Member –Check this box to make the wireless clients
(stations) with the same SSID not accessing for each other.
VPN – Check this box to make the wireless clients (stations)
with different VPN not accessing for each other.
Rate Control It controls the data transmission rate through wireless
connection.
Upload – Check Enable and type the transmitting rate for
data upload. Default value is 30,000 kbps.
Download – Type the transmitting rate for data download.
Default value is 30,000 kbps.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
By clicking the Wireless LAN>>Security Settings, a new web page will appear so that you
could configure the settings of WPA and WEP.
Item Description
WPA The WPA encrypts each frame transmitted from the radio
using the key, which either PSK (Pre-Shared Key) entered
manually in this field below or automatically negotiated via
802.1x authentication. Either 8~63 ASCII characters, such as
012345678(or 64 Hexadecimal digits leading by 0x, such as
"0x321253abcde...").
Pre-Shared Key (PSK) - Either 8~63 ASCII characters, such as
012345678..(or 64 Hexadecimal digits leading by 0x, such as
"0x321253abcde...").
Password Strength – The system will display the password
strength (represented with the word of weak, medium or
strong) of the PSK specified above.
WEP 64-Bit - For 64 bits WEP key, either 5 ASCII characters, such
as 12345 (or 10 hexadecimal digitals leading by 0x, such as
0x4142434445.)
128-Bit - For 128 bits WEP key, either 13 ASCII characters,
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Enable Mac Address Filter Select to enable the MAC Address filter for wireless LAN
identified with SSID 1 to 4 respectively. All the clients
(expressed by MAC addresses) listed in the box can be
grouped under different wireless LAN. For example, they can
be grouped under SSID 1 and SSID 2 at the same time if you
check SSID 1 and SSID 2.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
III-1-5 WPS
WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup) provides easy procedure to make network connection between
wireless station and wireless access point (vigor router) with the encryption of WPA and
WPA2.
Info WPS is available for the wireless station with WPS supported.
It is the simplest way to build connection between wireless network clients and vigor router.
Users do not need to select any encryption mode and type any long encryption passphrase to
setup a wireless client every time. He/she only needs to press a button on wireless client, and
WPS will connect for client and router automatically.
There are two methods to do network connection through WPS between AP and Stations:
pressing the Start PBC button or using PIN Code.
If you want to use PIN code, you have to know the PIN code specified in wireless client.
Then provide the PIN code of the wireless client you wish to connect to the vigor router.
For WPS is supported in WPA-PSK or WPA2-PSK mode, if you do not choose such mode in
Wireless LAN>>Security, you will see the following message box.
Please click OK and go back Wireless LAN>>Security to choose WPA-PSK or WPA2-PSK mode
and access WPS again.
Item Description
Enable WPS Check this box to enable WPS setting.
WPS Status Display related system information for WPS. If the wireless
security (encryption) function of the router is properly
configured, you can see ‘Configured’ message here.
SSID Display the SSID1 of the router. WPS is supported by SSID1
only.
Authentication Mode Display current authentication mode of the router. Only
WPA2/PSK and WPA/PSK support WPS.
Configure via Push Button Click Start PBC to invoke Push-Button style WPS setup
procedure. The router will wait for WPS requests from
wireless clients about two minutes. The WPS LED on the
router will blink fast when WPS is in progress. It will return to
normal condition after two minutes. (You need to setup WPS
within two minutes)
Configure via Client Please input the PIN code specified in wireless client you
PinCode wish to connect, and click Start PIN button. The WPS LED on
the router will blink fast when WPS is in progress. It will
return to normal condition after two minutes. (You need to
setup WPS within two minutes)
To meet the above requirement, two WDS modes are implemented in Vigor router. One is
Bridge, the other is Repeater. Below shows the function of WDS-bridge interface:
The major difference between these two modes is that: while in Repeater mode, the packets
received from one peer AP can be repeated to another peer AP through WDS links. Yet in
Bridge mode, packets received from a WDS link will only be forwarded to local wired or
wireless hosts. In other words, only Repeater mode can do WDS-to-WDS packet forwarding.
In the following examples, hosts connected to Bridge 1 or 3 can communicate with hosts
connected to Bridge 2 through WDS links. However, hosts connected to Bridge 1 CANNOT
communicate with hosts connected to Bridge 3 through Bridge 2.
Item Description
Mode Choose the mode for WDS setting. Disable mode will not
invoke any WDS setting. Bridge mode is designed to fulfill
the first type of application. Repeater mode is for the
second one.
Access Point Function Click Enable to make this router serve as an access point;
click Disable to cancel this function.
Status It allows user to send “hello” message to peers. Yet, it is
valid only when the peer also supports this function.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
or,
or
RTS Threshold (1 – 2347) Minimize the collision (unit is bytes) between hidden stations
to improve wireless performance.
Set the RTS threshold. Do not modify default value if you
don’t know what it is, default value is 2347.
Country Code Vigor router broadcasts country codes by following the
802.11d standard. However, some wireless stations will
detect / scan the country code to prevent conflict occurred.
If conflict is detected, wireless station will be warned and is
unable to make network connection. Therefore, changing
the country code to ensure successful network connection
will be necessary for some clients.
Item Description
SSID Display the SSID that the wireless station will use it to
connect with Vigor router.
Enable Check the box to enable the station control function.
Connection Time / Use the drop down list to choose the duration for the
Reconnection Time wireless client connecting /reconnecting to Vigor router. Or,
type the duration manually when you choose User defined.
Display All Station Control All the wireless stations connecting to Vigor router by using
List such SSID will be listed on Station Control List.
WEB Portal Setup Click it to access in to LAN>>Web Portal Setup page for
modifying the settings if required.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Scan It is used to discover all the connected AP. The results will be
shown on the box above this button.
Statistics It displays the statistics for the channels used by APs.
Add to If you want the found AP applying the WDS settings, please
type in the AP’s MAC address on the bottom of the page and
click Bridge or Repeater. Next, click Add to. Later, the MAC
address of the AP will be added to Bridge or Repeater field of
WDS settings page.
The wireless channel can be accessed by only one wireless station at the same time.
The principle behind the IEEE802.11 channel access mechanisms is that each station has
equal probability to access the channel. When wireless stations have similar data rate, this
principle leads to a fair result. In this case, stations get similar channel access time which is
called airtime.
However, when stations have various data rate (e.g., 11g, 11n), the result is not fair. The
slow stations (11g) work in their slow data rate and occupy too much airtime, whereas the
fast stations (11n) become much slower.
Take the following figure as an example, both Station A(11g) and Station B(11n) transmit data
packets through Vigor router. Although they have equal probability to access the wireless
channel, Station B(11n) gets only a little airtime and waits too much because Station A(11g)
spends longer time to send one packet. In other words, Station B(fast rate) is obstructed by
Station A(slow rate).
To improve this problem, Airtime Fairness is added for Vigor router. Airtime Fairness function
tries to assign similar airtime to each station (A/B) by controlling TX traffic. In the following
figure, Station B(11n) has higher probability to send data packets than Station A(11g). By this
way, Station B(fast rate) gets fair airtime and it's speed is not limited by Station A(slow rate).
Suitable environment:
Item Description
Enable Airtime Fairness Try to assign similar airtime to each wireless station by
controlling TX traffic.
Airtime Fairness – Click the link to display the following
screen of airtime fairness note.
After finishing this web page configuration, please click OK to save the settings.
Info Airtime Fairness function and Bandwidth Limit function should be mutually
exclusive. So their webs have extra actions to ensure these two functions
are not enabled simultaneously.
If dual-band is detected, the AP will let the wireless client connect to less congested wireless
LAN, such as 5GHz to prevent from network congestion.
Info To make Band Steering work successfully, SSID and security on 2.4GHz also
MUST be broadcasted on 5GHz.
Item Description
Enable Band Steering If it is enabled, Vigor router will detect if the wireless client
is capable of dual-band or not within the time limit.
Check Time…. – If the wireless station does not have the
capability of 5GHz network connection, the system shall wait
and check for several seconds (15 seconds, in default) to
make the 2.4GHz network connection. Specify the time limit
for Vigor router to detect the wireless client.
After finishing this web page configuration, please click OK to save the settings.
Same value
for 2.4GHz
and 5GHz
Same value
for 2.4GHz
and 5GHz
6. Now, Vigor router will let the wireless clients connect to less congested wireless LAN,
such as 5GHz to prevent from network congestion.
Item Description
Refresh Click this button to refresh the status of station list.
Add Click this button to add current typed MAC address into
Access Control.
Voice over IP network (VoIP) enables you to use your broadband Internet connection to make
toll quality voice calls over the Internet.
There are many different call signaling protocols, methods by which VoIP devices can talk to
each other. The most popular protocols are SIP, MGCP, Megaco and H.323. These protocols
are not all compatible with each other (except via a soft-switch server).
The Vigor V models support the SIP protocol as this is an ideal and convenient deployment for
the ITSP (Internet Telephony Service Provider) and softphone and is widely supported. SIP is
an end-to-end, signaling protocol that establishes user presence and mobility in VoIP
structure. Every one who wants to talk using his/her SIP Uniform Resource Identifier, “SIP
Address”. The standard format of SIP URI is
sip: user:password @ host: port
Some fields may be optional in different use. In general, "host” refers to a domain. The
“userinfo” includes the user field, the password field and the @ sign following them. This is
very similar to a URL so some may call it “SIP URL”. SIP supports peer-to-peer direct calling
and also calling via a SIP proxy server (a role similar to the gatekeeper in H.323 networks),
while the MGCP protocol uses client-server architecture, the calling scenario being very
similar to the current PSTN network.
After a call is setup, the voice streams transmit via RTP (Real-Time Transport Protocol).
Different codecs (methods to compress and encode the voice) can be embedded into RTP
packets. Vigor V models provide various codecs, including G.711 A/μ-law, G.723, G.726 and
G.729 A & B. Each codec uses a different bandwidth and hence provides different levels of
voice quality. The more bandwidth a codec uses the better the voice quality, however the
codec used must be appropriate for your Internet bandwidth.
Peer-to-Peer
Before calling, you have to know your friend’s IP Address. The Vigor VoIP Routers will build
connection between each other.
Vigor V models firstly apply efficient codecs designed to make the best use of available
bandwidth, but Vigor V models also equip with automatic QoS assurance. QoS Assurance
assists to assign high priority to voice traffic via Internet. You will always have the required
inbound and outbound bandwidth that is prioritized exclusively for Voice traffic over Internet
but you just get your data a little slower and it is tolerable for data traffic.
Our Vigor V models firstly apply efficient codecs designed to make the best use of available
bandwidth, but Vigor V models also equip with automatic QoS assurance. QoS Assurance
assists to assign high priority to voice traffic via Internet. You will always have the required
inbound and outbound bandwidth that is prioritized exclusively for Voice traffic over Internet
but you just get your data a little slower and it is tolerable for data traffic.
Item Description
Set VoIP service VoIP service provider - Use the drop down list to choose
provider domain the ISP which offers the VoIP service for your router.
SIP Port – Use the default setting (5060).
Set Account quickly Account Number/Name – Type the account number/name
registered to your ISP.
Password – Type the password for the account registered to
your ISP.
3. After finished the settings above, click Next for viewing summary of such connection.
After checking the box and click OK, the following page appears for you to configure secure
phone, IP call; and set NAT Traversal Setting, RTP for the VoIP function.
Item Description
Secure Phone Enable Secure Phone - It allows users to have encrypted RTP
stream with the peer side using the same protocol
(ZRTP+SRTP). Check this box to have secure call.
Enable SAS Voice Prompt - If it is enabled, SAS prompt will
be heard for both ends every time. If it is disabled, no SAS
Info If the incoming or outgoing calls do not match any entry on the phonebook,
the router will try to make the call "being protected". But, if the call ends
up "unprotected"(e.g. peer side does not support ZRTP+SRTP), the router
will not play out a warning message.
Info Selection items for Ring Port will differ according to the router you have.
Item Description
Index Click this link to access into next page for setting SIP
account.
Profile Display the profile name of the account.
Domain/Realm Display the domain name or IP address of the SIP registrar
server.
Proxy Display the domain name or IP address of the SIP proxy
server.
Account Name Display the account name of SIP address before @.
Codec Display the codec type for the account.
Ring Port Specify which port will ring when receiving a phone call.
Status Show the status for the corresponding SIP account. R means
such account is registered on SIP server successfully. – means
Click any index link to access into the following page for configuring SIP account.
Item Description
Profile Name Assign a name for this profile for identifying. You can type
similar name with the domain. For example, if the domain
name is draytel.org, then you might set draytel-1 in this
field.
Register via If you want to make VoIP call without register personal
information, please choose None and check the box to
achieve the goal. Some SIP server allows user to use VoIP
function without registering. For such server, please check
the box of Call without Registration. Choosing Auto is
recommended. The system will select a proper way for your
VoIP call.
Prefer Codec Select one of five codecs as the default for your VoIP calls.
The codec used for each call will be negotiated with the peer
party before each session, and so may not be your default
choice. The default codec is G.729A/B; it occupies little
bandwidth while maintaining good voice quality.
If your upstream speed is only 64Kbps, do not use G.711
codec. It is better for you to have at least 256Kbps upstream
if you would like to use G.711.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Click any index number to display the dial plan setup page.
Item Description
Enable Click this to enable this entry.
Phone Number The speed-dial number of this index. This can be any number
you choose, using digits 0-9 and * .
Display Name The Caller-ID that you want to be displayed on your friend’s
screen. This let your friend can easily know who’s calling
without memorizing lots of SIP URL Address.
SIP URL Enter your friend’s SIP Address.
Dial Out Account Choose one of the SIP accounts for this profile to dial out. It
is useful for both sides (caller and callee) that registered to
different SIP Registrar servers. If caller and callee do not use
the same SIP server, sometimes, the VoIP phone call
connection may not succeed. By using the specified dial out
account, the successful connection can be assured.
Loop through Choose PSTN to enable loop through function.
Backup Phone Number When the VoIP phone obstructs or the Internet breaks down
for some reasons, the backup phone will be dialed out to
replace the VoIP phone number. At this time, the phone call
will be changed from VoIP phone into PSTN call according to
the loop through direction chosen. Note that, during the
phone switch, the blare of phone will appear for a short
time. And when the VoIP phone is switched into the PSTN
phone, the telecom co. might charge you for the connection
fee. Please type in backup phone number for this VoIP phone
setting.
Secure Phone ZRTP+SRTP - It allows users to have encrypted RTP stream
with the peer side using the same protocol (ZRTP+SRTP).
Check this box to have secure call.
Cancel Return to previous web page.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Info If the incoming or outgoing calls do not match any entry on the phonebook,
the router will try to make the call "being protected". But, if the call ends
up "unprotected"(e.g. peer side does not support ZRTP+SRTP), the router
will not play out a warning message.
Item Description
Enable Check this box to invoke this setting.
Match Prefix It is used to match with the number you dialed and may be
modified by the action (add, strip or replace) with the OP
Number.
Mode None - No action.
Add - When you choose this mode, the OP number will be
added before the match prefix number for calling out
through the specific route.
Strip - When you choose this mode, the partial or whole
match prefix number will be deleted according to the OP
number. Take the above picture (Prefix Table Setup web
page) as an example, the OP number of 886 will be deleted
completely for the match prefix number is set with 886.
Replace - When you choose this mode, the OP number will
be replaced by the prefix number for calling out through
the specific VoIP interface. Take the above picture (Prefix
Table Setup web page) as an example, the prefix number of
03 will be replaced by 8863. For example: dial number of
“031111111” will be changed to “88631111111” and sent to
SIP server.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Additionally, you can set advanced settings for call barring such as Block Anonymous, Block
Unknown Domain or Block IP Address.
For Block Anonymous – this function can block the incoming calls without caller ID on the
interface (Phone port) specified in the following window. Such control also can be done based
on preconfigured schedules.
For Block Unknown Domain – this function can block incoming calls (through Phone port) from
unrecognized domain that is not specified in SIP accounts. Such control also can be done based
on preconfigured schedules.
For Block IP Address – this function can block incoming calls (through Phone port) coming from
IP address. Such control also can be done based on preconfigured schedules.
Item Description
Enable Check it to enable this entry.
Call Direction Determine the direction for the phone call, IN – incoming
call, OUT-outgoing call, IN & OUT – both incoming and
outgoing calls.
Barring Type Determine the type of the VoIP phone call, URI/URL or
number.
Specific URI/URL or This field will be changed based on the type you selected
Specific Number for barring Type.
Route All means all the phone calls will be blocked with such
mechanism.
Index (1-15) in Schedule Enter the index of schedule profiles to control the call
barring according to the preconfigured schedules. Refer to
section Applications>>Schedule for detailed
configuration.
Item Description
Enable Regional Check this box to enable this function.
Last Call Return [Miss] Sometimes, people might miss some phone calls. Please
dial number typed in this field to know where the last
phone call comes from and call back to that one.
Last Call Return [In] You have finished an incoming phone call, however you
want to call back again for some reason. Please dial
number typed in this field to call back to that one.
Last Call Return [Out] Dial the number typed in this field to call the previous
outgoing phone call again.
Call Forward [All][Act] Dial the number typed in this field to forward all the
incoming calls to the specified place.
Call Forward [Deact] Dial the number typed in this field to release the call
forward function.
Call Forward [Busy][Act] Dial the number typed in this field to forward all the
incoming calls to the specified place while the phone is
busy.
Call Forward [No Dial the number typed in this field to forward all the
Ans][Act] incoming calls to the specified place while there is no
answer of the connected phone.
Do Not Disturb [Act] Dial the number typed in this field to invoke the function of
DND.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Phone List Port – there are two phone ports provided here for you to
configure. Phone1/Phone2 allows you to set general settings
for PSTN phones.
Call Feature – A brief description for call feature will be
shown in this field for your reference.
Tone - Display the tone settings that configured in the
advanced settings page of Phone Index.
Gain - Display the volume gain settings for Mic/Speaker that
configured in the advanced settings page of Phone Index.
Default SIP Account – “draytel_1” is the default SIP account.
You can click the number below the Index field to change SIP
account for each phone port.
DTMF Relay – Display DTMF mode that configured in the
advanced settings page of Phone Index.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Hotline Check the box to enable it. Type in the SIP URL in the field
for dialing automatically when you pick up the phone set.
Session Timer Check the box to enable the function. In the limited time
that you set in this field, if there is no response, the
connecting call will be closed automatically.
T.38 Fax Function Check the box to enable T.38 fax function.
Error Correction Mode – choose a mode for error correction.
DND (Do Not Disturb) Set a period of peace time without disturbing by VoIP phone
mode call. During the period, the one who dial in will listen busy
tone, yet the local user will not listen any ring tone.
Index (1-15) in Schedule - Enter the index of schedule
profiles to control when the phone will ring and when will
not according to the preconfigured schedules. Refer to
section Application >>Schedule for detailed configuration.
Index (1-60) in Phone Book - Enter the index of phone book
profiles. Refer to section DialPlan – Phone Book for detailed
configuration.
CLIR (hide caller ID) Check this box to hide the caller ID on the display panel of
the phone set.
Call Waiting Check this box to invoke this function. A notice sound will
appear to tell the user new phone call is waiting for your
response. Click hook flash to pick up the waiting phone call.
Call Transfer Check this box to invoke this function. Click hook flash to
initiate another phone call. When the phone call connection
succeeds, hang up the phone. The other two sides can
In addition, you can press the Advanced button to configure tone settings, volume gain, MISC
and DTMF mode. Advanced setting is provided for fitting the telecommunication custom for
the local area of the router installed. Wrong tone settings might cause inconvenience for
users. To set the sound pattern of the phone set, simply choose a proper region to let the
system find out the preset tone settings and caller ID type automatically. Or you can adjust
tone settings manually if you choose User Defined. TOn1, TOff1, TOn2 and TOff2 mean the
cadence of the tone pattern. TOn1 and TOn2 represent sound-on; TOff1 and TOff2 represent
the sound-off.
Item Description
Region Select the proper region which you are located. The common
settings of Caller ID Type, Dial tone, Ringing tone, Busy
tone and Congestion tone will be shown automatically on
the page. If you cannot find out a suitable one, please choose
User Defined and fill out the corresponding values for dial
tone, ringing tone, busy tone, congestion tone by yourself for
VoIP phone.
InBand - Choose this one then the Vigor will send the
DTMF tone as audio directly when you press the keypad
on the phone.
OutBand - Choose this one then the Vigor will capture
the keypad number you pressed and transform it to
digital form then send to the other side; the receiver
will generate the tone according to the digital form it
receive. This function is very useful when the network
traffic congestion occurs and it still can remain the
accuracy of DTMF tone.
IV-1-6 Status
From this page, you can find codec, connection and other important call status for each port.
Item Description
Refresh Seconds Specify the interval of refresh time to obtain the latest VoIP
calling information. The information will update
immediately when the Refresh button is clicked.
A Virtual Private Network (VPN) is the extension of a private network that encompasses links
across shared or public networks like the Internet. In short, by VPN technology, you can send
data between two computers across a shared or public network in a manner that emulates the
properties of a point-to-point private link.
The VPN built is suitable for:
Communication between home office and customer
Secure connection between Teleworker, staff on business trip and main office
Exchange data between remote office and main office
POS between chain store and headquarters
Item Description
LAN-to-LAN Client Choose the client mode.
Mode Selection Route Mode/NAT Mode – If the remote network only allows
you to dial in with single IP, please choose NAT mode,
otherwise please choose Route Mode.
In this page, you have to select suitable VPN type for the VPN client profile. There are six
types provided here. Different type will lead to different configuration page. After
making the choices for the client profile, please click Next. You will see different
configurations based on the selection(s) you made.
Info The following descriptions for VPN Type are based on the Route Mode
specified in LAN-to-LAN Client Mode Selection.
When you choose PPTP (None Encryption) or PPTP (Encryption), you will see the
following graphic:
When you choose SSL, you will see the following graphic:
When you choose L2TP over IPsec (Nice to Have) or L2TP over IPsec (Must), you will see
the following graphic:
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for such profile. The length of the file is limited
to 10 characters.
VPN Dial-Out Through Use the drop down menu to choose a proper WAN interface
for this profile. This setting is useful for dial-out only.
Or,
3. After finishing the configuration, please click Next. The confirmation page will be
shown as follows. If there is no problem, you can click one of the radio buttons listed on
the page and click Finish to execute the next action.
Item Description
Go to the VPN Click this radio button to access VPN and Remote
Connection Access>>Connection Management for viewing VPN
Management Connection status.
Do another VPN Click this radio button to set another profile of VPN Server
Server Wizard Setup through VPN Server Wizard.
View more detailed Click this radio button to access VPN and Remote
configuration Access>>LAN to LAN for viewing detailed configuration.
Item Description
VPN Server Mode Choose the direction for the VPN server.
Selection Site to Site VPN – To set a LAN-to-LAN profile automatically,
please choose Site to Site VPN.
Remote Dial-in User –You can manage remote access by
maintaining a table of remote user profile, so that users can
be authenticated to dial-in via VPN connection.
Please choose a This item is available when you choose Site to Site VPN
LAN-to-LAN Profile (LAN-to-LAN) as VPN server mode. There are 32 VPN profiles
for users to set.
Please choose a This item is available when you choose Remote Dial-in User
Dial-in User Accounts (Teleworker) as VPN server mode. There are 32 VPN tunnels
for users to set.
Allowed Dial-in Type This item is available after you choose any one of dial-in user
account profiles. Next, you have to select suitable dial-in
type for the VPN server profile. There are several types
provided here (similar to VPN Client Wizard).
2. After making the choices for the server profile, please click Next. You will see different
configurations based on the selection you made. Here we take the examples of choosing
Site-to-Site VPN as the VPN Server Mode.
When you check PPTP/SSL, you will see the following graphic:
When you check PPTP & IPsec & L2TP (three types) or PPTP & IPsec (two types) or L2TP
with Policy (Nice to Have/Must), you will see the following graphic:
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for such profile. The length of the file is limited
to 10 characters.
User Name This field is used to authenticate for connection when you
select PPTP or L2TP with or without IPsec policy above.
The length of the name is limited to 11 characters.
Password This field is used to authenticate for connection when you
select PPTP or L2TP with or without IPsec policy above.
The length of the name is limited to 11 characters.
3. After finishing the configuration, please click Next. The confirmation page will be
shown as follows. If there is no problem, you can click one of the radio buttons listed on
the page and click Finish to execute the next action.
Item Description
Go to the VPN Click this radio button to access VPN and Remote
Connection Access>>Connection Management for viewing VPN
Management Connection status.
Do another VPN Click this radio button to set another profile of VPN Server
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Dial-In PPP Authentication PAP Only - elect this option to force the router to
authenticate dial-in users with the PAP protocol.
PAP/CHAP/MS-CHAP/MS-CHAPv2 - Selecting this option
means the router will attempt to authenticate dial-in users
with the CHAP protocol first. If the dial-in user does not
support this protocol, it will fall back to use the PAP protocol
for authentication.
Dial-In PPP Encryption Optional MPPE - This option represents that the MPPE
(MPPE) encryption method will be optionally employed in the router
for the remote dial-in user. If the remote dial-in user does
not support the MPPE encryption algorithm, the router will
transmit “no MPPE encrypted packets”. Otherwise, the MPPE
encryption scheme will be used to encrypt the data.
Require MPPE (40/128bits) - Selecting this option will
force the router to encrypt packets by using the MPPE
encryption algorithm. In addition, the remote dial-in
user will use 40-bit to perform encryption prior to using
128-bit for encryption. In other words, if 128-bit MPPE
encryption method is not available, then 40-bit
encryption scheme will be applied to encrypt the data.
Maximum MPPE - This option indicates that the router
will use the MPPE encryption scheme with maximum
bits (128-bit) to encrypt the data.
Mutual Authentication The Mutual Authentication function is mainly used to
PPTP LDAP Profile Configured LDAP profiles will be listed under such item.
Simply check the one you want to enable the PPP
authentication by LDAP server profiles.
However, if there is no profile listed, simply click the link of
PPTP LDAP Profile to create/add some new LDAP profiles
you want.
While using Radius or If PPP connection will be authenticated via RADIUS server or
LDAP Authentication LDAP profiles, it is necessary to specify the LAN profile for
the dial-in user to get IP from.
Encapsulating Security Payload (ESP) is a security protocol that provides data confidentiality
and protection with optional authentication and replay detection service.
Item Description
IKE Authentication This usually applies to those are remote dial-in user or node
Method (LAN-to-LAN) which uses dynamic IP address and
IPsec-related VPN connections such as L2TP over IPsec and
IPsec tunnel. There are two methods offered by Vigor router
for you to authenticate the incoming data coming from
remote dial-in user, Certificate (X.509) and Pre-Shared
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Click it to clear all indexes.
Index Click the number below Index to access into the setting page
Click each index to edit one peer digital certificate. There are three security levels of digital
signature authentication: Fill each necessary field to authenticate the remote peer. The
following explanation will guide you to fill all the necessary fields.
Item Description
Profile Name Type the name of the profile. The maximum length of the
name you can set is 32 characters.
Enable this account Check it to enable such account profile.
Accept Any Peer ID Click to accept any peer regardless of its identity.
Accept Subject Click to check one specific field of digital signature to accept
Alternative Name the peer with matching value. The field can be IP Address,
Domain, or E-mail Address. The box under the Type will
appear according to the type you select and ask you to fill in
corresponding setting.
Accept Subject Name Click to check the specific fields of digital signature to
accept the peer with matching value. The field includes
Country (C), State (ST), Location (L), Organization (O),
Organization Unit (OU), Common Name (CN), and Email
(E).
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
The router provides 32 access accounts for dial-in users. Besides, you can extend the user
accounts to the RADIUS server through the built-in RADIUS client function. The following
figure shows the summary table.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Click to clear all indexes.
Index Click the number below Index to access into the setting page
of Remote Dial-in User.
User Display the username for the specific dial-in user of the
LAN-to-LAN profile. The symbol ??? represents that the
profile is empty.
Active Check the box to activate such profile.
Status Display the access state of the specific dial-in user. The
symbol V and X represent the specific dial-in user to be
active and inactive, respectively.
Click each index to edit one remote user profile. Each Dial-In Type requires you to fill the
different corresponding fields on the right. If the fields gray out, it means you may leave it
untouched. The following explanation will guide you to fill all the necessary fields.
Item Description
User account and Enable this account - Check the box to enable this function.
Authentication Idle Timeout- If the dial-in user is idle over the limitation of
the timer, the router will drop this connection. By default,
the Idle Timeout is set to 300 seconds.
Allowed Dial-In Type PPTP - Allow the remote dial-in user to make a PPTP VPN
connection through the Internet. You should set the User
Name and Password of remote dial-in user below.
IPsec Tunnel - Allow the remote dial-in user to make an
IPsec VPN connection through Internet.
L2TP with IPsec Policy - Allow the remote dial-in user to
make a L2TP VPN connection through the Internet. You can
select to use L2TP alone or with IPsec. Select from below:
None - Do not apply the IPsec policy. Accordingly, the
VPN connection employed the L2TP without IPsec
policy can be viewed as one pure L2TP connection.
Nice to Have - Apply the IPsec policy first, if it is
applicable during negotiation. Otherwise, the dial-in
VPN connection becomes one pure L2TP connection.
Must -Specify the IPsec policy to be definitely applied
on the L2TP connection.
SSL Tunnel – Allow the remote dial-in user to make an SSL
VPN connection through Internet.
Specify Remote Node -You can specify the IP address of the
remote dial-in user, ISDN number or peer ID (used in IKE
aggressive mode).
Uncheck the checkbox means the connection type you select
above will apply the authentication methods and security
The following figure shows the summary table according to the item (All/Trunk) selected for
View.
The following shows profiles joined into VPN Load Balance and VPN Backup mechanism.
Item Description
View All – Click it to display the LAN to LAN profiles.
Trunk – Click it to display the Trunk profiles.
Set to Factory Default Click to clear all indexes.
Name Indicate the name of the LAN-to-LAN profile. The symbol ???
represents that the profile is empty.
Active V – means the profile has been enabled.
X – means the profile has not been enabled.
Status Indicate the status of individual profiles. The symbol V and X
represent the profile to be active and inactive, respectively.
1. Click each index to edit each profile and you will get the following page. Each
LAN-to-LAN profile includes 4 subgroups. If the fields gray out, it means you may leave it
untouched. The following explanations will guide you to fill all the necessary fields.
Item Description
Common Settings Profile Name – Specify a name for the profile of the
LAN-to-LAN connection.
Enable this profile - Check here to activate this profile.
VPN Dial-Out Through - Use the drop down menu to choose a
proper WAN interface for this profile. This setting is useful
for dial-out only.
WAN1 First/ WAN2 First/ WAN3 First /WAN4/LTE
First- While connecting, the router will use
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3/WAN4/LTE as the first channel for
VPN connection. If WAN1/WAN2/WAN3/WAN4/LTE
fails, the router will use another WAN interface
instead.
WAN1 Only /WAN2 Only/WAN 3 Only/WAN 4/LTE
Only- While connecting, the router will use
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3/WAN4/LTE as the only channel for
VPN connection.
WAN1 Only: Only establish VPN if WAN2 down - If
WAN2 failed, the router will use WAN1 for VPN
connection.
WAN2 Only: Only establish VPN if WAN1 down - If
WAN1 failed, the router will use WAN2 for VPN
connection.
Netbios Naming Packet
Item Description
Dial-In Settings Allowed Dial-In Type - Determine the dial-in connection
with different types.
PPTP - Allow the remote dial-in user to make a PPTP
VPN connection through the Internet. You should set
the User Name and Password of remote dial-in user
below.
IPsec Tunnel- Allow the remote dial-in user to trigger
an IPsec VPN connection through Internet.
L2TP with IPsec Policy - Allow the remote dial-in user
to make a L2TP VPN connection through the Internet.
You can select to use L2TP alone or with IPsec. Select
from below:
None - Do not apply the IPsec policy. Accordingly,
the VPN connection employed the L2TP without
IPsec policy can be viewed as one pure L2TP
connection.
Nice to Have - Apply the IPsec policy first, if it is
applicable during negotiation. Otherwise, the
dial-in VPN connection becomes one pure L2TP
connection.
Must - Specify the IPsec policy to be definitely
applied on the L2TP connection.
SSL Tunnel- Allow the remote dial-in user to trigger an
SSL VPN connection through Internet.
GRE over IPsec Enable IPsec Dial-Out function GRE over IPsec: Check this
Settings box to verify data and transmit data in encryption with GRE
over IPsec packet after configuring IPsec Dial-Out setting.
Both ends must match for each other by setting same virtual
IP address for communication.
Logical Traffic: Such technique comes from RFC2890. Define
logical traffic for data transmission between both sides of
TCP/IP Network My WAN IP –This field is only applicable when you select
Settings PPTP or L2TP with or without IPsec policy above. The default
value is 0.0.0.0, which means the Vigor router will get a PPP
IP address from the remote router during the IPCP
negotiation phase. If the PPP IP address is fixed by remote
side, specify the fixed IP address here. Do not change the
default value if you do not select PPTP or L2TP.
Remote Gateway IP - This field is only applicable when you
select PPTP or L2TP with or without IPsec policy above. The
default value is 0.0.0.0, which means the Vigor router will
get a remote Gateway PPP IP address from the remote router
during the IPCP negotiation phase. If the PPP IP address is
fixed by remote side, specify the fixed IP address here. Do
not change the default value if you do not select PPTP or
L2TP.
Remote Network IP/ Remote Network Mask - Add a static
route to direct all traffic destined to this Remote Network IP
Address/Remote Network Mask through the VPN connection.
For IPsec, this is the destination clients IDs of phase 2 quick
mode.
Local Network IP / Local Network Mask - Display the local
network IP and mask for TCP / IP configuration. You can
modify the settings if required.
More - Add a static route to direct all traffic destined to
more Remote Network IP Addresses/ Remote Network Masks
through the VPN connection. This is usually used when you
find there are several subnets behind the remote VPN router.
2. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Backup Profile List Set to Factory Default - Click to clear all VPN TRUNK-VPN
Backup mechanism profile.
No – The order of VPN TRUNK-VPN Backup mechanism
profile.
Status - “v” means such profile is enabled; “x” means such
profile is disabled.
Name - Display the name of VPN TRUNK-VPN Backup
mechanism profile.
Member1 - Display the dial-out profile selected from the
Member1 drop down list below.
Active - “Yes” means normal condition. “No” means the
state might be disabled or that profile currently is set with
Dial-in mode (for call direction) in LAN-to-LAN.
Type - Display the connection type for that profile, such as
IPsec, PPTP, L2TP, L2TP over IPsec (NICE), L2TP over
IPsec(MUST) and so on.
Member2 - Display the dial-out profile selected from the
Member2 drop down list below.
Advanced – This button is available only when LAN to LAN
profile (or more) is created.
Time for activating VPN TRUNK – VPN Load Balance mechanism profile
After finishing the connection for one tunnel, the other tunnel will dial out automatically
within two seconds. Therefore, you can choose any one of members under VPN Load Balance
for dialing out.
Time for activating VPN TRUNK –Dial-out when VPN Load Balance Disconnected
For there is one Tunnel created and connected successfully, to keep the load balance effect
between two tunnels, auto-dial will be executed within two seconds.
To close two tunnels of load balance after connecting, please click Disable for Status in
General Setup field.
4. Take a look for LAN-to-LAN profiles. Index 1 is chosen as Member1; index 2 is chosen as
Member2. For such reason, LAN-to-LAN profiles of 1 and 2 will be expressed in red to
indicate that they are fixed. If you delete the VPN TRUNK – VPN Backup/Load Balance
mechanism profile, the selected LAN-to-LAN profiles will be released and expressed in
black.
After setting profiles for load balance, you can choose any one of them and click Advance for
more detailed configuration. The windows for advanced load balance and backup are
different. Refer to the following explanation:
Item Description
Profile Name List the load balance profile name.
Load Balance Algorithm Round Robin – Based on packet base, both tunnels will send
the packet alternatively. Such method can reach the balance
of packet transmission with fixed rate.
Weighted Round Robin –Such method can reach the balance
of packet transmission with flexible rate. It can be divided
into Auto Weighted and According to Speed Ratio. Auto
Weighted can detect the device speed (10Mbps/100Mbps)
and switch with fixed value ratio (3:7) for packet
transmission. If the transmission rate for packets on both
sides of the tunnels is the same, the value of Auto Weighted
should be 5.5. According to Speed Ratio allows user to
adjust suitable rate manually. There are 100 groups of rate
ratio for Member1:Member2 (range from 1:99 to 99:1).
VPN Load Balance Policy Below shows the algorithm for Load Balance.
Edit – Click this radio button for assign a blank table for
configuring Binding Tunnel.
Insert after – Click this radio button to adding a new binding
tunnel table.
Advanced Backup
Item Description
Profile Name List the backup profile name.
ERD Mode ERD means “Environment Recovers Detection”.
Normal – choose this mode to make all dial-out VPN TRUNK
V-1-10 ZenMate
ZenMate is a Google Chrome plugin which can enhance the network security and protect the
user not to be monitored by local ISP, hackers or government when he/she browses the web
pages. It is a free-charge VPN service.
Item Description
Dial-out Tool General Mode - This filed displays the profile configured in
LAN-to-LAN (with Index number and VPN Server IP address).
The VPN connection built by General Mode does not support
VPN backup function.
A-1 How to Build a LAN-to-LAN VPN Between Remote Office and Headquarter
via IPsec Tunnel (Main Mode)
3. Click any index number to open the configuration page. Type a name which is easy for
identification for such profile (in this case, type VPN Server), and check the box of
Enable This Profile. For Vigor router will be set as a server, the call direction shall be
set as Dial-in and set 0 as Idle Timeout.
5. Continue to navigate to the TCP/IP Network Settings for setting the LAN IP for remote
side.
3. Click any index number to open the configuration page. Type a name which is easy for
identification for such profile (in this case, type VPN Client), and check the box of
Enable This Profile. For such Vigor router will be set as a client, the call direction shall
be set as Dial-out. Check the box of Always on for a permanent VPN connection.
5. Continue to navigate to the TCP/IP Network Settings for setting the LAN IP for the
remote side.
3. Fill in the form to purchase the ZenMate service and you will get the service activation
code.
5. A window will pop-up for notifying the configurations for ZenMate VPN will be saved to
VPN profile index 32. Click OK to continue.
6. Wait a few seconds and you will see the VPN Status changed from “Not Activated” to
“Connected”. ZenMate VPN is connected now!
8. A window will pop-up for confirming the ZenMate settings change, click OK to continue.
10. You may also see the status of ZenMate VPN tunnel via VPN and Remote Access >>
Connection Management page.
An SSL VPN (Secure Sockets Layer virtual private network) is a form of VPN that can be used
with a standard Web browser.
There are two benefits that SSL VPN provides:
It is not necessary for users to preinstall VPN client software for executing SSL VPN
connection.
There are less restrictions for the data encrypted through SSL VPN in comparing with
traditional VPN.
Item Description
Bind to WAN Choose and check WAN interface(s) for SSL VPN tunnel
establishment.
Port Such port is set for SSL VPN server. It will not affect the HTTPS
Port configuration set in System Maintenance>>Management.
In general, the default setting is 443.
Server Certificate When the client does not set any certificate, default
certificate will be used for HTTPS and SSL VPN server. Choose
any one of the user-defined certificates from the drop down
list if users set several certificates previously. Otherwise,
choose Self-signed to use the router’s built-in default
certificate. The default certificate can be used in SSL VPN
server and HTTPS Web Proxy.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Name Display the name of the profile that you create.
URL Display the URL.
Active Display current status (active or inactive) of such profile.
Item Description
Name Type name of the profile. The length of the name is limited to
15 characters.
URL Type the address (function variation or IP address) or path of
the proxy server.
Host IP Address If you type function variation as URL, you have to type
corresponding IP address in this filed. Such field must match
with URL setting.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Name Display the application name of the profile that you create.
Host Address Display the IP address for VNC/RDP or SMB path.
Service Display the type of the service selected, e.g., VNC/RDP/SMB.
Active Display current status (active or inactive) of the selected
profile.
Item Description
Enable Application Check the box to enable such profile.
IP Address If you choose VNC or RDP, you have to type the IP address
for this protocol.
Port If you choose VNC or RDP, you have to specify the port used
for this protocol. The default setting is 5900.
Idle Timeout If you choose VNC, you have to specify the time for
disconnecting the SSL VPN tunnel.
Screen Size If you choose RDP, you have to choose the screen size for
such application.
SMB Path If you choose SMB, you have to specify the path of the SMB
service.
Item Description
User account and Enable this account - Check the box to enable this function.
Authentication Idle Timeout- If the dial-in user is idle over the limitation of
the timer, the router will drop this connection. By default, the
Idle Timeout is set to 300 seconds.
User Name - This field is applicable when you select PPTP or
L2TP with or without IPsec policy above. The length of the
name/password is limited to 23 characters.
Password - This field is applicable when you select PPTP or
L2TP with or without IPsec policy above. The length of the
name/password is limited to 19 characters.
Enable Mobile One-Time Passwords (mOTP) - Check this box
to make the authentication with mOTP function.
PIN Code – Type the code for authentication (e.g, 1234).
Secret – Use the 32 digit-secret number generated by mOTP in
the mobile phone (e.g., e759bb6f0e94c7ab4fe6).
Allowed Dial-In Type PPTP - Allow the remote dial-in user to make a PPTP VPN
connection through the Internet. You should set the User
Name and Password of remote dial-in user below.
IPSec Tunnel - Allow the remote dial-in user to make an IPSec
VPN connection through Internet.
L2TP with IPSec Policy - Allow the remote dial-in user to
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Click to clear all indexes.
Index Display the number of the client which connecting to FTP
server.
Name Display the name of the group profile.
Click any index number link to open the following page for detailed configuration.
Item Description
Enable Check this box to enable such profile.
Group Name Type a name for such profile. The length of the name is
limited to 23 characters.
Access Authority Specify the authority for such profile.
At present, Vigor router allows you to create SSL Web Proxy
and SSL Application profiles used for SSL VPN. The available
profiles will be displayed here for you to select.
Authentication Methods It can determine the authentication method used for such
profile.
Local User DataBase – The system will do the authentication
by using the user defined account profiles (in VPN and Remote
Access>>Remote Dial-In User). The enabled profiles will be
listed in the Available User Account on the left box. To add a
profile into a group, simply choose the one from the left box
and click the >> button. It will be displayed in the Selected
User Account on the right box. For detailed information about
configuring the profile setting, refer to Objects Setting>>IP
Group.
RADIUS – The RADIUS server will do the authentication by using
the username and password
TACACS+ - The TACACS+ will do the authentication by using
the username and password.
LDAP / Active Directory - If it is checked, the LDAP / AD
server will do the authentication by using the username,
password, information stated on the selected profiles.
If the above three options are enabled, the system will do the
authentication based on them in sequence.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Next, users can open SSL VPN>> Online Status to view logging status of SSL VPN.
Item Description
Active User Display current user who visits SSL VPN server.
Host IP Display the IP address for the host.
Time out Display the time remaining for logging out.
Action You can click Drop to drop certain login user from the router's
SSL Portal UI.
A digital certificate works as an electronic ID, which is issued by a certification authority (CA).
It contains information such as your name, a serial number, expiration dates etc., and the
digital signature of the certificate-issuing authority so that a recipient can verify that the
certificate is real. Here Vigor router support digital certificates conforming to standard
X.509.
Any entity wants to utilize digital certificates should first request a certificate issued by a CA
server. It should also retrieve certificates of other trusted CA servers so it can authenticate
the peer with certificates issued by those trusted CA servers.
Here you can manage generate and manage the local digital certificates, and set trusted CA
certificates. Remember to adjust the time of Vigor router before using the certificate so that
you can get the correct valid period of certificate.
Below shows the menu items for Certificate Management.
Item Description
Generate Click this button to open Generate Certificate Request
window.
Type in all the information that the window requests. Then
click Generate again.
Import Click this button to import a saved file as the certification
information.
Refresh Click this button to refresh the information listed below.
View Click this button to view the detailed settings for certificate
request.
Delete Click this button to delete selected name with certification
information.
GENERATE
Click this button to open Generate Certificate Signing Request window. Type in all the
information that the window request such as certifcate name (used for identifying different
certificate), subject alternative name type and relational settings for subject name. Then
click GENERATE again.
After clicking GENERATE, the generated information will be displayed on the window below:
IMPORT
Vigor router allows you to generate a certificate request and submit it the CA server, then
import it as “Local Certificate”. If you have already gotten a certificate from a third party,
you may import it directly. The supported types are PKCS12 Certificate and Certificate with a
private key.
Click this button to import a saved file as the certification information. There are three types
of local certificate supported by Vigor router.
Item Description
Upload Local Certificate It allows users to import the certificate which is generated by
Vigor router and signed by CA server.
If you have done well in certificate generation, the Status of
the certificate will be shown as “OK”.
Upload PKCS12 It allows users to import the certificate whose extensions are
Certificate usually .pfx or .p12. And these certificates usually
need passwords.
Note that PKCS12 is a standard for storing private keys and
certificates securely. It is used in (among other things)
Netscape and Microsoft Internet Explorer with their import
and export options.
Upload Certificate and It is useful when users have separated certificates and private
Private Key keys. And the password is needed if the private key is
encrypted.
View
Click this button to view the detailed settings for certificate request.
Info You have to copy the certificate request information from above window.
Next, access your CA server and enter the page of certificate request, copy
the information into it and submit a request. A new certificate will be
issued to you by the CA server. You can save it.
Delete
Click this button to remove the selected certificate.
Info Root CA can be deleted but not edited. If you want to modify the settings
for a Root CA, please delete the one and create another one by clicking
Create Root CA.
Creating a Root CA
Click Create Root CA to open the following page. Type in all the information that the window
request such as certifcate name (used for identifying different certificate), subject
alternative name type and relational settings for subject name. Then click GENERATE again.
For viewing each trusted CA certificate, click View to open the certificate detail information
window. If you want to delete a CA certificate, choose the one and click Delete to remove all
the certificate information.
While the broadband users demand more bandwidth for multimedia, interactive applications,
or distance learning, security has been always the most concerned. The firewall of the Vigor
router helps to protect your local network against attack from unauthorized outsiders. It also
restricts users in the local network from accessing the Internet. Furthermore, it can filter out
specific packets that trigger the router to build an unwanted outgoing connection.
Firewall Facilities
The users on the LAN are provided with secured protection by the following firewall facilities:
User-configurable IP filter (Call Filter/ Data Filter).
Stateful Packet Inspection (SPI): tracks packets and denies unsolicited incoming data
Selectable Denial of Service (DoS) /Distributed DoS (DDoS) attacks protection
IP Filters
Depending on whether there is an existing Internet connection, or in other words “the WAN
link status is up or down”, the IP filter architecture categorizes traffic into two: Call Filter
and Data Filter.
Call Filter - When there is no existing Internet connection, Call Filter is applied to all
traffic, all of which should be outgoing. It will check packets according to the filter rules.
If legal, the packet will pass. Then the router shall “initiate a call” to build the Internet
connection and send the packet to Internet.
Data Filter - When there is an existing Internet connection, Data Filter is applied to
incoming and outgoing traffic. It will check packets according to the filter rules. If legal,
the packet will pass the router.
The following illustrations are flow charts explaining how router will treat incoming traffic
and outgoing traffic respectively.
Item Description
Item Description
Filter Select Pass or Block for the packets that do not match with
the filter rules.
Sessions Control The number typed here is the total sessions of the packets
that do not match the filter rule configured in this page. The
default setting is 60000.
Quality of Service Choose one of the QoS rules to be applied as firewall rule.
For detailed information of setting QoS, please refer to the
related section later.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
To edit or add a filter, click on the set number to edit the individual set. The following page
will be shown. Each filter set contains up to 7 rules. Click on the rule number button to edit
each rule. Check Active to enable the rule.
Item Description
Filter Rule Click a button numbered (1 ~ 7) to edit the filter rule. Click
the button will open Edit Filter Rule web page. For the
detailed information, refer to the following page.
Active Enable or disable the filter rule.
Comment Enter filter set comments/description. Maximum length is
23–character long.
Direction Display the direction of packet.
Src IP / Dst IP Display the IP address of source /destination.
Service Type Display the type and port number of the packet.
Item Description
Comments Enter filter set comments/description. Maximum length is
14- character long.
Direction Set the direction of packet flow. It is for Data Filter only.
For the Call Filter, this setting is not available since Call
Filter is only applied to outgoing traffic.
From the IP Group drop down list, choose the one that you
want to apply. Or use the IP Object drop down list to
choose the object that you want.
Protocol Specify the protocol(s) which this filter rule will apply to.
Source Port / (=) – when the first and last value are the same, it indicates
Destination Port one port; when the first and last values are different, it
indicates a range for the port and available for this service
type.
(!=) – when the first and last value are the same, it
indicates all the ports except the port defined here; when
the first and last values are different, it indicates that all
the ports except the range defined here are available for
this service type.
(>) – the port number greater than this value is available.
(<) – the port number less than this value is available for
this profile.
Item Description
Pass Immediately Packets matching the rule will be passed immediately.
APP Enforcement - Select an APP Enforcement profile for
global IM/P2P application blocking. If there is no profile for
you to select, please choose [Create New] from the drop
down list in this page to create a new profile. All the hosts
in LAN must follow the standard configured in the APP
Enforcement profile selected here. For detailed
information, refer to the section of APP Enforcement
profile setup. For troubleshooting needs, you can specify to
record information for IM/P2P by checking the Log box. It
will be sent to Syslog server. Please refer to section
Syslog/Mail Alert for more detailed information.
URL Content Filter - Select one of the URL Content Filter
profile settings (created in CSM>> URL Content Filter) for
applying with this router. Please set at least one profile for
choosing in CSM>> URL Content Filter web page first. Or
choose [Create New] from the drop down list in this page
to create a new profile. For troubleshooting needs, you can
specify to record information for URL Content Filter by
checking the Log box. It will be sent to Syslog server. Please
refer to section Syslog/Mail Alert for more detailed
information.
Web Content Filter - Select one of the Web Content Filter
profile settings (created in CSM>> Web Content Filter) for
applying with this router. Please set at least one profile for
anti-virus in CSM>> Web Content Filter web page first. Or
choose [Create New] from the drop down list in this page
to create a new profile. For troubleshooting needs, you can
specify to record information for Web Content Filter by
checking the Log box. It will be sent to Syslog server. Please
refer to section Syslog/Mail Alert for more detailed
information.
DNS Filter - Select one of the DNS Filter profile settings
(created in CSM>>DNS Filter) for applying with this router.
Please set at least one profile in CSM>> Web Content
Filter web page first. Or click the DNS Filter link from the
drop down list in this page to create a new profile.
Block Immediately Packets matching the rule will be dropped immediately.
4. After choosing the mechanism, click Next to get the summary page for reference.
Item Description
Check to enable the Check this box to enable the filter rule.
Filter Rule
Comments Enter filter set comments/description. Maximum length is
14- character long.
Index(1-15) Set PCs on LAN to work at certain time interval only. You
may choose up to 4 schedules out of the 15 schedules
pre-defined in Applications >> Schedule setup. The
default setting of this field is blank and the function will
always work.
Clear sessions when Check this box to clear the sessions when the above
schedule ON schedule profiles are applied.
Direction Set the direction of packet flow. It is for Data Filter only.
For the Call Filter, this setting is not available since Call
Filter is only applied to outgoing traffic.
From the IP Group drop down list, choose the one that you
want to apply. Or use the IP Object drop down list to
choose the object that you want.
Service Type Click Edit to access into the following dialog to choose a
suitable service type.
3. When you finish the configuration, please click OK to save and exit this page.
Item Description
Enable Dos Defense Check the box to activate the DoS Defense Functionality.
Select All Click this button to select all the items listed below.
Enable SYN flood defense Check the box to activate the SYN flood defense function.
Once detecting the Threshold of the TCP SYN packets from
the Internet has exceeded the defined value, the Vigor
router will start to randomly discard the subsequent TCP
SYN packets for a period defined in Timeout. The goal for
this is prevent the TCP SYN packets’ attempt to exhaust the
limited-resource of Vigor router.
By default, the threshold and timeout values are set to
2000 packets per second and 10 seconds, respectively. That
means, when 2000 packets per second received, they will
be regarded as “attack event” and the session will be
paused for 10 seconds.
Enable UDP flood defense Check the box to activate the UDP flood defense function.
Once detecting the Threshold of the UDP packets from the
Internet has exceeded the defined value, the Vigor router
will start to randomly discard the subsequent UDP packets
for a period defined in Timeout.
The default setting for threshold and timeout are 2000
The way we can use is to set two rules under Firewall. For Rule 1 of Set 2 under
Firewall>>Filter Setup is used as the default setting, we have to create a new rule starting
from Filter Rule 2 of Set 2.
1. Access into the web user interface of Vigor router.
2. Open Firewall>>Filter Setup. Click the Set 2 link, choose Advance Mode and choose the
Filter Rule 2 button.
Info In default, the router will check the packets starting with Set 2, Filter Rule
2 to Filter Rule 7. If Block If No Further Match for is selected for Filter, the
firewall of the router would check the packets with the rules starting from
Rule 3 to Rule 7. The packets not matching with the rules will be processed
according to Rule 2.
4. Next, set another rule. Just open Firewall>>Filter Setup. Click the Set 2 link and
choose the Filter Rule 3 button.
5. Check the box of Check to enable the Filter Rule. Type the comments (e.g., open_ip).
Click the Edit button for Source IP.
7. Now, check the content of Source IP is correct or not. The action for Filter shall be set
with Pass Immediately. Then, click OK to save the settings.
Now, all the settings are configured well. Only the computers with the IP addresses within
192.168.1.10 ~ 192.168.1.20 can access to Internet.
Info The priority of URL Content Filter is higher than Web Content Filter.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Profile Display the number of the profile which allows you to click to
set different policy.
Name Display the name of the APP Enforcement Profile.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for the CSM profile. The maximum length of the
name you can set is 15 characters.
Select All Click it to choose all of the items in this page.
Clear All Uncheck all the selected boxes.
Enable Check the box to select the APP to be blocked by Vigor
router.
Adv A button under Enable check box allows you to open a pop up
window to specify activity for that APP.
The profiles configured here can be applied in the Firewall>>General Setup and
Firewall>>Filter Setup pages as the standard for the host(s) to follow.
Item Description
Upgrade Setting APPE Module Version – Display current version status of
APPE signature.
New version from the Internet – Download button is
available only when Vigor router detects new APPE version.
After clicking it, a dialog will appear with information added
to such new version. Click OK to exit the dialog and start the
signature upgrade.
Upgrade via interface – Choose one of the WAN interfaces as
a channel for APPE signature upgrade.
Setup Download Server Specify the download server by typing the URL of the server
located. Or you can click Find more link to search the one
you want.
Signature authentication/download message – Display the
status of APPE Signature Upgrade.
Upgrade Manually Import – Click this button to open the following page. Press
Choose File to locate the signature file which downloaded
Upgrade Automatically Scheduled Update - Check the box to make Vigor router
upgrading the APPE signature based on the schedule
configured here.
After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for the CSM profile. The maximum length of the
name you can set is 15 characters.
Priority It determines the action that this router will apply.
Both: Pass – The router will let all the packages that match
with the conditions specified in URL Access Control and Web
Feature below passing through. When you choose this
setting, both configuration set in this page for URL Access
Control and Web Feature will be inactive.
Both:Block –The router will block all the packages that
match with the conditions specified in URL Access Control
and Web Feature below. When you choose this setting, both
configuration set in this page for URL Access Control and Web
Feature will be inactive.
Either: URL Access Control First – When all the packages
matching with the conditions specified in URL Access Control
and Web Feature below, such function can determine the
priority for the actions executed. For this one, the router
will process the packages with the conditions set below for
URL first, then Web feature second.
Either: Web Feature First –When all the packages matching
with the conditions specified in URL Access Control and Web
Feature below, such function can determine the priority for
the actions executed. For this one, the router will process
the packages with the conditions set below for web feature
first, then URL second.
URL Access Control Enable URL Access Control - Check the box to activate URL
Access Control. Note that the priority for URL Access
Control is higher than Restrict Web Feature. If the web
content match the setting set in URL Access Control, the
router will execute the action specified in this field and
ignore the action specified under Restrict Web Feature.
Prevent web access from IP address - Check the box to deny
any web surfing activity using IP address, such as
http://202.6.3.2. The reason for this is to prevent someone
dodges the URL Access Control. You must clear your browser
cache first so that the URL content filtering facility operates
properly on a web page that you visited before.
Action – This setting is available only when Either : URL
Access Control First or Either : Web Feature First is
selected.
Pass - Allow accessing into the corresponding webpage
with the keywords listed on the box below.
Block - Restrict accessing into the corresponding
webpage with the keywords listed on the box below.
If the web pages do not match with the keyword set
here, it will be processed with reverse action.
Exception List – Specify the object profile(s) as the
exception list which will be processed in an opposite manner
to the action selected above.
Group/Object Selections – The Vigor router provides several
frames for users to define keywords and each frame supports
multiple keywords. The keyword could be a noun, a partial
noun, or a complete URL string. Multiple keywords within a
frame are separated by space, comma, or semicolon. In
addition, the maximal length of each frame is 32-character
long. After specifying keywords, the Vigor router will decline
the connection request to the website whose URL string
matched to any user-defined keyword. It should be noticed
that the more simplified the blocking keyword list is, the
more efficiently the Vigor router performs.
After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Info 1 Web Content Filter (WCF) is not a built-in service of Vigor router but a
service powered by Commtouch. If you want to use such service (trial or
formal edition), you have to perform the procedure of activation first. For
the service of formal edition, please contact with your dealer/distributor
for detailed information.
Info 2 Commtouch is merged by Cyren, and GlobalView services will be continued
to deliver powerful cloud-based information security solutions! Refer to:
http://www.prnewswire.com/news-releases/commtouch-is-now-cyren-239
025151.html
Item Description
Activate Click it to access into MyVigor for activating WCF service.
Setup Query Server It is recommended for you to use the default setting,
auto-selected. You need to specify a server for categorize
searching when you type URL in browser based on the web
content filter profile.
Setup Test Server It is recommended for you to use the default setting,
auto-selected.
Find more Click it to open http://myvigor.draytek.com for searching
another qualified and suitable server.
Test a site to verify Click this link to do the verification.
whether it is categorized
Set to Factory Default Click this link to retrieve the factory settings.
Administration Message You can type the message manually for your necessity or
click Default Message button to get the default text
displayed on the field of Administration Message.
Preview – A dialog will appear to display the message typed
in the Administration Message.
Cache None – the router will check the URL that the user wants to
access via WCF precisely, however, the processing rate is
normal. Such item can provide the most accurate URL
matching.
L1 – the router will check the URL that the user wants to
access via WCF. If the URL has been accessed previously, it
Eight profiles are provided here as Web content filters. Simply click the index number under
Profile to open the following web page. The items listed in Categories will be changed
according to the different service providers. If you have and activate another web content
filter license, the items will be changed simultaneously. All of the configuration made for web
content filter will be deleted automatically. Therefore, please backup your data before you
change the web content filter license.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for the CSM profile. The maximum length of the
name you can set is 15 characters.
Black/White List Enable – Activate white/black list function for such profile.
Group/Object Selections – Click Edit to choose the group or
object profile as the content of white/black list.
After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Info For DNS filter must use the WCF service profile to filter the packets,
therefore WCF license must be activated first. Otherwise, DNS filter does
not have any effect on packets.
Item Description
DNS Filter Profile Table It displays a list of different DNS filter profiles (with
specified WCF and UCF).
Click the profile link to open the following page. Then, type
the name of the profile and specify WCF/UCF based on your
requirement.
After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Or
Click System Maintenance>>Activation to open the following page.
8. Check to see the confirmation email with the title of New Account Confirmation
Letter from myvigor.draytek.com.
9. Click the Activate my Account link to enable the account that you created. The following
screen will be shown to verify the register process is finished. Please click Login.
11. Now, click Login. Your account has been activated. You can access into MyVigor server to
activate the service (e.g., WCF) that you want.
3. Type your personal information in this page and then click Continue.
7. Click the Activate my Account link to enable the account that you created. The following
screen will be shown to verify the register process is finished. Please click Login.
Now, click Login. Your account has been activated. You can access into MyVigor server to
activate the service (e.g., WCF) that you want.
4. Next time when someone accesses facebook via this router, the web page would be
blocked and the following message would be displayed instead.
3. Open CSM>>URL Content Filter Profile. Click an index number to open the setting
page.
4. Configure the settings as the following figure.
5. When you finished the above steps, click OK. Then, open Firewall>>General Setup.
5. When you finished the above steps, please open Firewall>>General Setup.
6. Click the Default Rule tab. Choose the profile just configured from the drop down list in
the field of URL Content Filter. Now, users cannot open any web page with the word
“facebook” inside.
For the system setup, there are several items that you have to know the way of configuration:
System Status, TR-069, Administrator Password, User Password, Login Page Greeting,
Configuration Backup, Syslog /Mail Alert, Time and Date, Management, Reboot System,
Firmware Upgrade and Activation.
Below shows the menu items for System Maintenance.
Item Description
Model Name Display the model name of the router.
Firmware Version Display the firmware version of the router.
Build Date/Time Display the date and time of the current firmware build.
LAN MAC Address
- Display the MAC address of the LAN Interface.
IP Address
- Display the IP address of the LAN interface.
Item Description
ACS Server On Choose the interface for the router connecting to ACS server.
ACS Server URL/Username/Password – Such data must be typed
according to the ACS (Auto Configuration Server) you want to
link. Please refer to Auto Configuration Server user’s manual
for detailed information.
Test With Inform – Click it to send a message based on the
event code selection to test if such CPE is able to
communicate with VigorACS SI server.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Administrator Password Old Password - Type in the old password. The factory default
setting for password is “admin”.
New Password -Type in new password in this field. The
length of the password is limited to 23 characters.
Confirm Password -Type in the new password again.
Administrator Local User The administrator can login web user interface of Vigor
router to modify all of the settings to fit the requirements.
This feature allows other user in LAN who can access into the
web user interface with the same privilege of the
administrator.
Local User – Check the box to enable the local user
configuration.
Local User List – It displays the username of the local user.
User Name – Give a user name for the local user.
Password – Type the password for the local user.
When you click OK, the login window will appear. Please use the new password to access into
the web user interface again.
Item Description
Enable User Mode for After checking this box, you can access into the web user
simple web configuration interface with the password typed here for simple web
configuration.
The settings on simple web user interface will be different
with full web user interface accessed by using the
administrator password.
Password Type in new password in this field. The length of the
password is limited to 31 characters.
Confirm Password Type in the new password again.
Password Strength Display the security strength of the password specified
above.
Set to Factory Default Click to return to the factory default setting.
When you click OK, the login window will appear. Please use the new password to access into
the web user interface again. Below shows an example for accessing into User Operation with
User Password.
2. Check the box of Enable User Mode for simple web configuration to enable user mode
operation. Type a new password in the field of New Password and click OK.
4. Log out Vigor router web user interface by clicking the Logout button.
5. The following window will be open to ask for username and password. Type the new user
password in the filed of Password and click Login.
Settings to be configured in User Mode will be less than settings in Admin Mode. Only basic
configuration settings will be available in User Mode.
Item Description
Enable Check this box to enable the login customization function.
Login Page Title Type a brief description (e.g., Welcome to DrayTek) which
will be shown on the heading of the login dialog.
Welcome Message and Type words or sentences here. It will be displayed for
Bulletin bulletin message. In addition, it can be displayed on the
login dialog at the bottom.
Note that do not type URL redirect link here.
Preview Click it to display the preview of the login window based on
the settings on this web page.
Set to Factory Default Click to return to the factory default setting.
Below shows an example of login customization with the information typed in Login
Description and Bulletin.
Item Description
Restore Choose File – Click it to specify a file to be restored.
Restore configuration except the login password - If the
password settings shall not be restored and applied to
Vigor2860, simply check this box to get rid of password
settings.
Click Restore to restore the configuration. If the file is
encrypted, the system will ask you to type the password to
decrypt the configuration file.
Backup Click it to perform the configuration backup of this router.
Protect with password- For the sake of security, the
configuration file for the router can be encrypted.
2. Click Backup button to get into the following dialog. Click Save button to open another
dialog for saving configuration as a file.
3. In Save As dialog, the default filename is config.cfg. You could give it another name by
yourself.
4. Click Save button, the configuration will download automatically to your computer as a
file named config.cfg.
The above example is using Windows platform for demonstrating examples. The Mac or Linux
platform will appear different windows, but the backup function is still available.
Restore Configuration
1. Go to System Maintenance >> Configuration Backup. The following windows will be
popped-up, as shown below.
2. Click Choose File button to choose the correct configuration file for uploading to the
router.
3. Click Restore button and wait for few seconds, the following picture will tell you that
the restoration procedure is successful.
Item Description
Router Name Display the name for such router configured in System
Maintenance>>Management.
If there is no name here, simply lick the link to access into
System Maintenance>>Management to set the router name.
Server IP Address -The IP address of the Syslog server.
Destination Port - Assign a port for the Syslog protocol.
Mail Syslog – Check the box to recode the mail event on
Syslog.
Enable syslog message - Check the box listed on this web
page to send the corresponding message of firewall, VPN,
User Access, Call, WAN, Router/DSL information to Syslog.
Item Description
Current System Time Click Inquire Time to get the current time.
Use Browser Time Select this option to use the browser time from the remote
administrator PC host as router’s system time.
Use Internet Time Select to inquire time information from Time Server on the
Internet using assigned protocol.
Time Server Type the web site of the time server.
Priority Choose Auto or IPv6 First as the priority.
Time Zone Select the time zone where the router is located.
Enable Daylight Saving Check the box to enable the daylight saving. Such feature is
available for certain area.
Advanced – Click it to open a pop up dialog.
Use the default time setting or set user defined time for your
requirement.
Automatically Update Select a time interval for updating from the NTP server.
Interval
VII-1-9 SNMP
This page allows you to configure settings for SNMP and SNMPV3 services.
The SNMPv3 is more secure than SNMP through the encryption method (support AES and DES)
and authentication method (support MD5 and SHA) for the management needs.
Item Description
Enable SNMP Agent Check it to enable this function.
Get Community Set the name for getting community by typing a proper
Privacy Password Type a password for privacy. The maximum length of the
text is limited to 23 characters.
For IPv4
Item Description
Router Name Type in the router name provided by ISP.
Default: Disable If it is enabled, the function of auto-logout for web user
The web user interface will be open until you click the
Logout icon manually.
For IPv6
Item Description
Management Access Allow management from the Internet - Enable the checkbox
to allow system administrators to login from the Internet.
Click Regeneration to open Regenerate Self-Signed Certificate window. Type in all the
information that the window request such as certifcate name (used for identifying different
certificate), subject alternative name type and relational settings for subject name. Then
click GENERATE.
Index (1-15) in Schedule Setup - You can type in four sets of time schedule for performing
system reboot. All the schedules can be set previously in Applications >> Schedule web page
and you can use the number that you have set in that web page.
If you want to reboot the router using the current configuration, check Using current
configuration and click Reboot Now. To reset the router settings to default values, check
Using factory default configuration and click Reboot Now. The router will take 5 seconds to
reboot the system.
Info When the system pops up Reboot System web page after you configure web
settings, please click Reboot Now to reboot your router for ensuring normal
operation and preventing unexpected errors of the router in the future.
Click the button of Check The Latest Firmware to open a pop up window displaying the
newest firmware version released for such Vigor router.
Choose the one you need and click Download. After that, click Select to specify the one you
just download. Then, click Upgrade. The system will upgrade the firmware of the router
automatically.
VII-1-15 Activation
There are three ways to activate WCF on vigor router, using Service Activation Wizard, by
means of CSM>>Web Content Filter Profile or via System Maintenance>>Activation.
After you have finished the setting profiles for WCF (refer to Web Content Filter Profile), it is
the time to activate the mechanism for your computer.
Click System Maintenance>>Activation to open the following page for accessing
http://myvigor.draytek.com.
Item Description
Activate via Interface Choose WAN interface used by such device for activating
Web Content Filter.
Activate The Activate link brings you accessing into
www.vigorpro.com to finish the activation of the account
and the router.
Authentication Message As for authentication information of web filter, the process
of authenticating will be displayed on this field for your
Item Description
User Name Display the name of the existed user profile. To modify the
detailed settings, simply click the user name link to access
into the web page for modification.
Radius Check the box to turn on the security authentication service
offered by internal RADIUS server for the user profile.
Uncheck the box to turn off ecurity authentication service
offered by internal RADIUS server for the user profile.
If you check the box next to such item, all of the user profiles
listed in this page will be enabled with RADIUS service
enabled vice versa.
Local 802.1X Check the box to turn on the security authentication service
offered by Local 802.1X server for the user profile.
Uncheck the box to turn off ecurity authentication service
offered by Local 802.1X server for the user profile.
If you check the box next to such item, all of the user profiles
listed in this page will be enabled with Local 802.1X service
enabled; vice versa.
Info For the detailed setting (such as IP address, port number) configuration of
internal RADIUS, refer to Applications>>RADIUS/TACACS+.
For the detailed setting (such as IP address, port number) configuration of
Local 802.1X, refer to LAN>>Wired 802.1X and Wireless LAN>>Security.
Sessions Limit
A PC with private IP address can access to the Internet via NAT router. The router will
generate the records of NAT sessions for such connection. The P2P (Peer to Peer) applications
(e.g., BitTorrent) always need many sessions for procession and also they will occupy over
resources which might result in important accesses impacted. To solve the problem, you can
use limit session to limit the session procession for specified Hosts.
Bandwidth Limit
The downstream or upstream from FTP, HTTP or some P2P applications will occupy large of
bandwidth and affect the applications for other programs. Please use Limit Bandwidth to
make the bandwidth usage more efficient.
However, each node may take different attitude toward packets with high priority marking
since it may bind with the business deal of SLA among different DS domain owners. It’s not
easy to achieve deterministic and consistent high-priority QoS traffic throughout the whole
network with merely Vigor router’s effort.
To activate the function of limit session, simply click Enable and set the default session limit.
Available settings are explained as follows:
Item Description
Session Limit Enable - Click this button to activate the function of limit
session.
Disable - Click this button to close the function of limit
session.
After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
To activate the function of limit bandwidth, simply click Enable and set the default upstream
and downstream limit.
Available settings are explained as follows:
Item Description
Bandwidth Limit Enable - Click this button to activate the function of limit
bandwidth.
IP Routed Subnet – Check this box to apply the bandwidth
limit to the second subnet specified in LAN>>General Setup.
Disable - Click this button to close the function of limit
bandwidth.
Default TX limit - Define the default speed of the upstream
for each computer in LAN.
Default RX limit - Define the default speed of the
downstream for each computer in LAN.
Allow auto adjustment…- Check this box to make the best
utilization of available bandwidth.
Limitation List Display a list of specific limitations that you set on this web
page.
Item Description
General Setup Index – Display the WAN/LTE interface number that you can
edit.
Status – Display if the WAN interface is available for such
function or not.
Bandwidth – Display the inbound and outbound bandwidth
setting for the WAN interface.
Direction – Display which direction that such function will
influence.
Class 1/Class2/Class 3/Others – Display the bandwidth
percentage for each class.
UDP Bandwidth Control –Display the UDP bandwidth control
is enabled or not.
Online Statistics –Display an online statistics for quality of
service for your reference.
Setup – Allow to configure general QoS setting for WAN
interface.
Class Rule Index – Display the class number that you can edit.
Name – Display the name of the class.
Rule – Allow to configure detailed settings for the selected
Class.
Service Type – Allow to configure detailed settings for the
service type.
Enable the First Priority When this feature is enabled, the VoIP SIP/UDP packets will be
for VoIP SIP/RTP sent with highest priority.
SIP UDP Port – Set a port number used for SIP.
Online Statistics
Display an online statistics for quality of service for your reference. This feature is available
only when the Quality of Service for WAN interface is enabled.
Item Description
Enable the QoS Control The factory default for this setting is checked.
Please also define which traffic the QoS Control settings will
apply to.
IN- apply to incoming traffic only.
OUT-apply to outgoing traffic only.
BOTH- apply to both incoming and outgoing traffic.
Check this box and click OK, then click Setup link again. You
will see the Online Statistics link appearing on this page.
WAN Inbound Bandwidth It allows you to set the connecting rate of data input for
other WAN. For example, if your ADSL supports 1M of
downstream and 256K upstream, please set 1000kbps for this
box. The default value is 10000kbps.
WAN Outbound Bandwidth It allows you to set the connecting rate of data output for
other WAN. For example, if your ADSL supports 1M of
downstream and 256K upstream, please set 256kbps for this
box. The default value is 10000kbps.
Reserved Bandwidth Ratio It is reserved for the group index in the form of ratio of
reserved bandwidth to upstream speed and reserved
bandwidth to downstream speed.
Enable UDP Bandwidth Check this and set the limited bandwidth ratio on the right
Control field. This is a protection of TCP application traffic since UDP
application traffic such as streaming video will exhaust lots
of bandwidth.
Outbound TCP ACK The difference in bandwidth between download and upload
Info The rate of outbound/inbound must be smaller than the real bandwidth to
ensure correct calculation of QoS. It is suggested to set the bandwidth value
for inbound/outbound as 80% - 85% of physical network speed provided by
ISP to maximize the QoS performance.
2. After you click the Edit link, you will see the following page. Now you can define the
name for that Class. In this case, “Test” is used as the name of Class Index #1.
Item Description
ACT Check this box to invoke these settings.
Ethernet Type Please specify which protocol (IPv4 or IPv6) will be used for
this rule.
Local Address Click the Edit button to set the local IP address (on LAN) for
the rule.
Remote Address Click the Edit button to set the remote IP address (on
LAN/WAN) for the rule.
4. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
2. After you click the Edit link, you will see the following page.
Item Description
Service Name Type in a new service for your request. The maximum length
of the name you can set is 11 characters.
Service Type Choose the type (TCP, UDP or TCP/UDP or other) for the new
service.
Port Configuration Type - Click Single or Range as the Type. If you select
Range, you have to type in the starting port number and the
end porting number on the boxes below.
Port Number – Type in the starting port number and the end
porting number here if you choose Range as the type.
5. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
By the way, you can set up to 10 service types. If you want to edit/delete an existed service
type, please select the radio button of that one and click Edit/Edit for modification.
Item Description
Enable/Disable Click Enable to activate APP QoS function.
Click Disable to deactivate APP QoS function.
Traceable The protocol listed below is traceable by Vigor router.
Each tab offers different types of protocols to fit your
request.
Untraceable The protocol listed below is not easy to be traced by Vigor
router.
Each tab offers different types of protocols to fit your
2. You will get the following page. Click the Edit link for Class 1.
4. Check the box of ACT. Click Edit to specify the local address.
5. In the pop-up window, choose Range Address as the Address Type and type the start IP
address and end IP address in relational fields. Click OK to save the settings and exit the
window.
8. Do the same steps to add class rules for IPTV and Data/Email with IP addresses as shown
below.
and
10. In the Setup page, check the box of Enable the QoS Control. Type 30, 50 and 15 in the
boxes for VoIP, IPTV and Data/Email respectively. Check the box of Enable UDP
Bandwidth Control.
11. Click OK to save the settings. The class rules for WAN1 are defined as shown below.
2. Click Setup link of WAN(1/2/3/4). Make sure the QoS Control on the left corner is
checked. And select BOTH in Direction.
4. Return to previous page. Enter the Name of Index Class #1 by clicking Edit link. Type the
name “E-mail” for Class 1. Click OK to save the settings.
5. Click the Setup link for WAN2. The user can set reserved bandwidth (e.g., 25%) for
E-mail using protocol POP3 and SMTP. Click OK to save the settings.
6. Return to previous page. Enter the Name of Index Class #2 by clicking Edit link. In this
index, the user will set reserved bandwidth for HTTPS. And click OK.
10. Click Edit for Class 3 to open a new window. In this index, the user will set reserved
bandwidth for VPN.
11. Click Add to open the following window. Check the ACT box, first.
User Management is a security feature which disallows any IP traffic (except DHCP-related
packets) from a particular host until that host has correctly supplied a valid username and
password. Instead of managing with IP address/MAC address, User Management function
manages hosts with user account. Network administrator can give different firewall policies
or rules for different hosts with different User Management accounts. This is more flexible
and convenient for network management. Not only offering the basic checking for Internet
access, User Management also provides additional firewall rules, e.g. CSM checking for
protecting hosts.
Info Filter rules configured under Firewall usually are applied to the host (the
one that the router installed) only. With user management, the rules can be
applied to every user connected to the router with customized profiles.
Item Description
Mode There are two modes offered here for you to choose. Each
mode will bring different filtering effect to the users
involved.
User-Based - If you choose such mode, the router will apply
the filter rules configured in User Management>>User
Profile to the users.
Rule-Based –If you choose such mode, the router will apply
the filter rules configured in Firewall>>General Setup and
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
To set the user profile, please click any index number link to open the following page. Notice
that profile 1 (admin) and profile 2 (Dial-In User) are factory default settings. Profile 2 is
reserved for future use.
Item Description
Enable this account Check this box to enable such user profile.
User Name Type a name for such user profile (e.g., LAN_User_Group_1,
WLAN_User_Group_A, WLAN_User_Group_B, etc). When a
user tries to access Internet through this router, an
authentication step must be performed first. The user has to
type the User Name specified here to pass the
authentication. When the user passes the authentication,
he/she can access Internet via this router. However the
accessing operation will be restricted with the conditions
configured in this user profile.
The maximum length of the name you can set is 24
characters.
Password Type a password for such profile (e.g., lug123,
wug123,wug456, etc). When a user tries to access Internet
through this router, an authentication step must be
performed first. The user has to type the password specified
here to pass the authentication. When the user passes the
authentication, he/she can access Internet via this router
with the limitation configured in this user profile.
The maximum length of the password you can set is 24
characters.
Confirm Password Type the password again for confirmation.
Idle Timeout If the user is idle over the limitation of the timer, the
network connection will be stopped for such user. By
– Click this box to set and increase the time quota for
such profile.
Enable Data Quota Data Quota means the total amount for data transmission
allowed for the user. The unit is MB/GB.
– Click this box to set and increase the data quota for
such profile.
Local 802.1X Check the box to enable security authenticated via 802.1X
server.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Please click any index number link to open the following page.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this user group.
Available User Objects You can gather user profiles (objects) from User Profile page
within one user group. All the available user objects that you
have created will be shown in this box. Notice that user
object, Admin and Dial-In User are factory settings. User
defined profiles will be numbered with 3, 4, 5 and so on.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Refresh Seconds Use the drop down list to choose the time interval of
refreshing data flow that will be done by the system
automatically.
With User Management authentication function, before a valid username and password have
been correctly supplied, a particular client will not be allowed to access Internet through the
router. There are three ways for authentication: Web, Telnet and Alert Tool.
With Mozilla Firefox, you may get the following warning message. Select I
Understand the Risks.
After that, the web authentication window will appear. Input the user name and the
password for your account (defined in User Management) and click Login.
If the authentication is successful, the client will be redirected to the original web site
that he tried to access. In this example, it is http://www.draytek.com . Furthermore, you
will get a popped up window as the following. Then you can access the Internet.
In above description, you access an external web site to trigger the authentication. You
may also directly access the router’s Web UI for authentication. Both HTTP and HTTPS
are supported, for example http://192.168.1.1 or https://192.168.1.1 . Replace
192.168.1.1 with your router’s real IP address, and add the port number if the default
management port has been modified.
If the authentication is successful, you will get the Welcome Message that is set in the
User Management >> General Setup page.
Also you will get a Tracking Window if you don’t block the pop-up window.
Don’t setup a user profile in User Management and a VPN Remote Dial-in user profile
with the same Username. Otherwise, you may get unexpected result. It is because the
If SSL Tunnel or SSL Web Proxy is disabled in the VPN profile, a User
Management account and a remote dial-in VPN profile can use the same
Username, even with different passwords. However, we recommend you to use
different usernames for different user profiles in User Management and VPN
profiles.
2. Type the password for authentication and press Enter. The message User login
successful will be displayed with the expired time (if configured).
Info Here expired time is “Unlimited” means the Time Quota function is not
enabled for this account. After login, this account will not be expired
until it is logout.
3. In the Web interface of router, the configuration page of Time Quota is shown as below.
You will get the following message. The expired time is shown after you login.
After you run out the available time, you can’t use this account any more until the
administrator manually adds additional time for you.
2. You may get the VigorPro Alert Notice Tool from the following link:
http://www.draytek.com/user/SupportDLUtility.php
Info 1 Any modification to the Firewall policy will break down the
connections of all current users. They all have to authenticate again
for Internet access.
Info 2 The administrator may check the current users from User Online
Status page.
Example 1:Users can see the message for landing page after logging into Internet
successfully
1. Open the web user interface of Vigor2860.
2. Open User Management -> General Setup to get the following page. In the field of
Landing Page, please type the words of “Login Success”. Please note that the
maximum number of characters to be typed here is 255.
3. Now you can enable the Landing Page function. Open User Management -> User Profile
and click one of the index number (e.g., index number 3) links.
5. Open any browser (e.g., FireFox, Internet Explorer). The logging page will appear and
asks for username and password. Please type the correct username and password.
6. Click Login. If the logging is successful, you will see the message of Login Success from
the browser you use.
2. Next, enable the Landing Page function. Open User Management -> User Profile and
click one of the index number (e.g., index number 3) links.
3. In the following page, check the box of Landing page and click OK to save the settings.
5. Click Login. If the logging is successful, you will be directed into the website of
www.draytek.com.
Vigor2860 can build virtual private network (VPN) between itself and any other TR-069 CPE by
the function of central VPN management. In addition, it can be treated as a server (called
CVM server) which can manage TR-069 CPE for periodical firmware upgrade, configuration
backup and restoring configuration.
Item Description
CVM SSL Port Check the box to enable the port setting.
Type the port number in the box.
CVM Port Check the box to enable the port setting.
Type the port number in the box.
WAN IP for Remote For Vigor router can manage only the client from WAN
Connection interface, therefore you have to specify which interface will
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
IPsec Mode Choose Aggressive or Main as the IPsec Mode.
Security Method Choose one of the following methods (AH or ESP) for the
security of data transmission. For example, choose AH to specify
the IPsec protocol for the Authentication Header protocol. The data
will be authenticated but not be encrypted.
Encryption Type Choose one of the selections as the encryption type.
Local Subnet Type the IP address and subnet mask of local host.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Managed Devices List This area displays device icons (up to 8) for the CPE managed
by Vigor2860 series.
Edit – To modify the name and location of specific CPE, click
the one you want and click the Edit button. A pop up window
will appear. Simply change the name and/or location
manually.
Item Description
Refresh Click it to refresh current page.
USB Disk
- It means a USB disk connecting to
Vigor2860.
- When there is no
USB disk connecting to Vigor2860, such message will be
displayed in this field.
Click the icon to see the content inside the USB disk.
Item Description
Profile Name Type the name of the maintenance profile.
Enable Check it to enable such profile.
Only Run Once Check it to activate such profile running for once.
Device Name The drop down list will display all the CPE devices detected by
Vigor2860 series. Choose the one which will be applied with
such new created profile.
Router Name/ It displays the name and model of Vigor router.
Router Model
Action Type There are three actions for you to choose for such profile.
Item Description
CPE VPN Connection List
VPN Display the name of the LAN-to-LAN profile.
It is generated automatically when you click the
PPTP/IPsec/Advanced button to build the VPN connection
between Vigor2860 and remote CPE.
Type Display the dial-in type and the authentication method.
Remote IP Display the IP address of the remote CPE and the interface.
Virtual Network Display the IP address and subnet mask of Vigor2860 series.
Tx Pkts Display the number of the transmitted packets.
Tx Rate(Bps) Display the number of the transmitted rate.
Rx Pkts Display the number of the received packets.
Rx Rate(Bps) Display the number of the received rate.
Up Time Display the connection time of such VPN.
Item Description
Display Mode Choose the mode you want to display the related information
on the following table.
Stop record when fulls – when the capacity of CVM log is
full, the system will stop recording.
Always record the new event – only the newest events
will be recorded by the system.
Device Name Display the name of the managed CPE.
Description Name Display the brief explanation for the managed CPE.
Time & date Display the time and date that the managed CPE scanned by
Vigor2860 series.
Action Type Display the action that Vigor2860 series will perform for the
managed CPE.
Message Display the information for each event.
The Alert page offers brief information to identify the CPE connected to Vigor2860 series.
A-1 CVM Application - How to manage the CPE (router) through Vigor2860
series?
To manage CPEs through Vigor2860 series, you have to set URL on CPE first and set username
and password for Vigor2860 series. For this section, we use Vigor2850 series as the example.
All the CPE configuration will be done through Vigor2850 series.
3. In the following page, check the boxes for CVM Port and CVM SSL Port to enable the port
setting. Type the values for CVM Port, CVM SSL Port, Username, and Password
respectively. Remember the values configured in this page.
3. In the field of ACS Server, type the URL (IP address with port number) of Vigor2860
series and type the same Username and Password defined on the page of Central VPN
Management>>General Setup in Vigor2860 series. Then, click Enable for CPE Client and
then click OK to save the settings.
6. Open WAN>>Internet Access. Use the drop down list of Access Mode on WAN1 to select
MPoA (RFC1483/2684). Then, click Details Page.
7. Click Specify an IP address. Type correct WAN IP address, subnet mask and gateway IP
address for your CPE. Then click OK.
4. The selected CPE will be moved and displayed on Managed Devices List which means it is
controlled / managed by Vigor2860 series from now on.
3. Click the device icon (marked with ) and click the PPTP/IPsec button.
4. Wait for a moment. If VPN is built successfully, related information will be displayed on
CPE VPN Connection List.
Note: The profile name is created automatically by the system. Do not modify any value in
such page to avoid VPN error.
In the field of Profile Name, type a name for such maintenance profile; check Enable;
and choose the one you want to perform firmware upgrade from Device Name drop down
list. From the Action Type, choose Firmware Upgrade. Type the file/path of the newest
firmware or click Select to locate it. Specify the Schedule profile. At last, click OK.
5. Now, a new maintenance profile has been created.
Click the icon of Vigor2850 and click Edit and view the software version. Another way to
check if the firmware upgrade is completed or not, simply open Central VPN
Management>>Log & Alert.
Vigor2860 can manage the access points supporting AP management via Central AP
Management.
AP Map
AP Map is helpful to determine the best location for VigorAP in a room. A floor plan of a room
is required to be uploaded first. By dragging and dropping available VigorAP icon from the list
to the floor plan, the placement with the best wireless coverage will be clearly indicated
through simulated signal strength
AP Maintenance
Vigor router can execute configuration backup, configuration restoration, firmware upgrade
and remote reboot for the APs managed by the router. It is very convenient for the
administrator to process maintenance without accessing into the web user interface of the
access point.
VII-5-1 Dashboard
This page shows VigorAP’s information about Status, Event Log, Total Traffic or Station
Number by displaying VigorAP icon, text and histogram. Just move and click your mouse
cursor on Status, Event Log, Total Traffic or Station Number. Corresponding web pages will
be open immediately.
To access into the web user interface of VigorAP, simply move your mouse cursor on the
VigorAP icon and click it. The system will guide you to access into the web user interface of
VigorAP.
Item Description
Index Click the index number link for viewing the settings summary
of the access point.
Device Name The name of the AP managed by Vigor router will be displayed
here.
IP Address Display the true IP address of the access point.
SSID Display the SSID configured for the access point(s) connected
to Vigor2860.
Ch. Display the channel used by the access point.
STA List Display the number of wireless clients (stations) connecting to
the access point.
In which, 0/64 means that up to 64 clients are allowed to
connect to the access point. But, now no one connects to the
access point.
The number displayed on the left side means 2.4GHz; and the
number displayed on the right side means 5GHz.
AP List Display the number of the AP around the device.
Uptime Display the duration of the AP powered up.
Version Display the firmware version used by the access point.
Password Vigor2860 can get related information of the access point by
accessing into the web user interface of the access point.
This button is used to modify the logging password of the
connected access point.
Check the box on the left side of the selected profile to modify the content of the profile. The
Clone, Edit and Apply To Device buttons will be available then.
Item Description
Profile Display the name of the profile.
The default profile cannot be renamed.
Main SSID Display the SSID configured by such wireless profile.
Security Display the security mode selected by such wireless profile.
Multi-SSID Enable means multiple SSIDs (more than one) are active.
Disable means only SSID1 is active.
WLAN ACL Display the name of the access control list.
Rate Control Display the upload and/or download transmission rate.
Clone It can copy settings from an existing WLAN profile to another
WLAN profile.
First, you have to check the box of the existing profile as the
original profile. Second, click Clone. The following dialog will
appear.
Simply choose the device you want from Existing Device field.
Click >> to move the device to Selected Device field. Then,
click OK.
The selected WLAN profile will be applied to the selected
access point immediately. Later the access point will reboot.
Apply to Local WLAN Profile configured in this page is specified for VigorAP
connected to Vigor router.
If required, these settings also can be applied to Vigor router.
Select and check one of wireless profiles and click this button
to apply the settings onto the WI-Fi wireless settings
configured for such Vigor router.
Info The function of Auto Provision is available for the default WLAN profile.
5. When you finished the above web page configuration, click Finish to exit and return to
the first page. The modified WLAN profile will be shown on the web page.
Info Config Backup can be performed to one AP at one time. Others functions
(e.g., Config Restore, Firmware Upgrade, Remote Reboot can be performed
to more than one AP at one time by using Vigor2860.
Item Description
Action There are four actions provided by Vigor router to manage the
access points.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to perform the action.
VII-5-5 AP Map
This function is helpful to determine the best location for VigorAP in a room. A floor plan of a
room is required to be uploaded first. By dragging and dropping available VigorAP icon from
the list to the floor plan, the placement with the best wireless coverage will be clearly
indicated through simulated signal strength.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Click the link to clear current page configuration.
Profile Click the link to to view or edit the AP Map.
Location Display a brief description (e.g., ground, roof) of the AP Map.
Online APs Display the number of VigorAP configured and powered up.
Total APs Display the total number of VigorAP configured.
Clients Display the number of clients accessing Internet through the
VigorAP.
Dimension(m) Display the width and length of the AP map.
View Click it to review the layout for the selected AP map.
Item Description
Location (Profile Name) Type a name (e.g., groudfloor) for the AP map profile.
Upload Map Click the Select button to choose an image file (only JPG
and PNG are supported) for floor plan.
Cancel Click it to cancel the configuration.
Next Click it to go to the next configuration page.
2. Click Next. The configuration page with floor plan will be shown as follows.
4. Choose the signal strength (e.g., 30% in this case) from User Define drop down list. Click
Apply.
5. Adjust the AP on the map to find out which place can have the best wireless coverage. At
last, click Save.
The horizontal axis represents time; the vertical axis represents the transmission rate (in
kbps).
Item Description
Enable Neighbor AP Detection – The access point(s) registered to
Vigor2860 will be used to detect other access points and send
the scanned results to Vigor2860. Later, the scanned result
will be displayed on this page.
Local WLAN Detection – The router will detect all the access
points through wireless LAN connection.
Specify the access points which are classified under each type.
Refresh Min(s) Use the drop down list to specify the time to refresh the web
page.
Refresh Click such link to refresh the web page immediately.
Ch Display the channel used by the detected access point.
SSID Display the SSID specified for the detected access point.
Mode Display the mode (AP or Ad Hoc) used by the detected access
point.
All the APs detected by Vigor router will be treated as unknown APs. You have to specify
which AP is friendly and which one is Rogue respectively. Follow the steps below to perform
the classification of access points.
1. Click the radio button on one of the access points. In this case, DrayTek-LAN-A is
selected.
Item Description
AP’s MAC Address The MAC address of the selected AP will be displayed here
automatically.
AP’s SSID The SSID of the selected AP will be displayed here
automatically.
Add to Friendly APs - If the selected AP shall be treated as Friendly
AP, simply click Add to change its classification from unknown
to Friendly.
Rogue APs - If the selected AP shall be treated as rogue AP,
simply click Add to change its classification from unknown to
Rogue.
Delete From Rogue APs - If you want to change the classification of the
rogue AP, simply choose the one and click Delete. Later, the
page will refresh and the one will be classified as Unknown.
Friendly APs - If you want to change the classification of the
Item Description
Enable Check the box to enable such function.
Mode It is used to determine the operation mode when the system
detects overload between access points.
By Station Number –The operation of load balance will be
executed based on the station number configured in this page.
It is used to limit the allowed number for the station
connecting to the access point. The purpose is to prevent lots
of stations connecting to access point at the same time and
causing traffic unbalanced. Please define the required station
number for WLAN (2.4GHz) and WLAN (5GHz) separately.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
In this case, a device named with AP800_00507F6EE4980 has been detected by Vigor
router.
2. Click the WLAN Profile tab to get the following page. Check the box of the default
profile to make the Edit button be available. Then, click the Edit button.
3. When the following configuration page appears, make the changes you want and check
Apply to All APs. Then, click Next to access into the next page.
4. The following page allows you to modify related settings for 2.4G SSID of managed AP.
Make the changes you want for 2.4G SSID. Click Next for next page.
VII-6-1 Status
VigorSwitch listed below Status means the switch is managed by Viogr2860; VigorSwitch listed
below New Switch List means it is not managed by Vigor2860 yet.
Please note that, Shutdown Port is available for LAN port of VigorSwitch connects to a LAN
device. When it is checked, after clicking OK, the network connection between that device
and VigorSwitch will be terminated.
Item Description
Index Click the number link to access into the switch profile.
Note: Each connected VigorSwitch will have one setting
profile. If there are many switches connected to Vigor2860,
different index number will be used to represent different
VigorSwitch.
Name Display the user defined name of VigorSwitch.
Group Display the group name of VigorSwitch(es).
IP Address Display the IP address of VigorSwitch.
MAC Address Display the MAC address of VigorSwitch.
Model Display the model name of VigorSwitch.
Password Click it to display the account information including
username and password.
Delete Profile Click the mark of “X” to delete the switch profile.
2. After finished the settings, click VLAN tab to open following page.
Blank page due to LAN>>VLAN not configured previously:
3. Click OK to save VLAN configuration. Then, click Port tab to access the following page:
Item Description
Description If required, type a brief description to explain the device
connected to VigorSwitch via the LAN port.
Shutdown Port Shutdown – The port (e.g, Port 10 in this case) which is used
to connect VigorSwitch and Vigor2860 will not be shutdown
by Vigor2860 series.
Other LAN ports of VigorSwitch allow to connect to any LAN
device. When it is checked, after clicking OK, the network
connection between that device and VigorSwitch will be
terminated.
Schedule – Two sechule profiles can be specified here to
force Vigor2860 executing specific action to VigorSwitch.
4. Click OK to save the changes and then click Send to Device. Settings will be sent to
VigorSwitch immediately.
VII-6-3 Group
Different switches can be classified into different group(s). Specifc password for a group can
be defined and applied to every switch uder that group.
Through the common password setting, it is not necessary for the system administrator to
remember various login passwords to access into different VigorSwitch devices.
Item Description
Group Name Type a name as the group name. Different switches can be
classified within a group.
Group Password Type a password that administrator can use to access into
the managed VigorSwitch connecting to Vigor2860 series. All
of the switches under the same group can be accessed into
via such group password.
Existing Switch Display all of the VigorSwitch devices connecting to
Vigor2860.
Member Switch Choose the switches you want to group and click the button
“>>” to move the selected devices onto the field of Member
Switch. Devices under Member Switch will be grouped under
such group profile.
OK Click it to save the configuration.
Cancel Click it to exit the setting page without saving any change.
Item Description
Selection Action Action Type – Four actions including configuration backup,
configuration restore, remote reboot and factory reset are
offered by Vigor2860 to perform on VigorSwitch.
Vigor router can be used to connect with many types of external devices. In order to control
or manage the external devices conveniently, open External Devices to make detailed
configuration.
Item Description
External Device Syslog Check this box to display information of the detected device
on Syslog.
External Device Auto Check this box to detect the external device automatically
Discovery and display on this page.
From this web page, check the box of External Device Auto Discovery. Later, all the
available devices will be displayed in this page with icons and corresponding information. You
can change the device name if required or remove the information for off-line device
whenever you want.
For IPs in a range and service ports in a limited range usually will be applied in configuring
router’s settings, therefore we can define them with objects and bind them with groups for
using conveniently. Later, we can select that object/group that can apply it. For example, all
the IPs in the same department can be defined with an IP object (a range of IP address).
VIII-1-1 IP Object
You can set up to 192 sets of IP Objects with different conditions.
Item Description
View Use the drop down list to choose a type (Single Address,
Range Address, Subnet Address, Mac Address or all) that IP
object with the selected type will be shown on this page.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile. Maximum 15 characters are
allowed.
Interface Choose a proper interface.
MAC Address Type the MAC address of the network card which will be
controlled.
Start IP Address Type the start IP address for Single Address type.
End IP Address Type the end IP address if the Range Address type is
selected.
Subnet Mask Type the subnet mask if the Subnet Address type is selected.
Invert Selection If it is checked, all the IP addresses except the ones listed
above will be applied later while it is chosen.
4. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration. Below is
an example of IP objects settings.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the group profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile. Maximum 15 characters are
allowed.
Interface Choose WAN, LAN or Any to display all the available IP
objects with the specified interface.
Available IP Objects All the available IP objects with the specified interface
chosen above will be shown in this box.
Selected IP Objects Click >> button to add the selected IP objects in this box.
3. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the object profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile. Maximum 15 characters are
allowed.
Address Type Determine the address type for the IPv6 address.
Select Single Address if this object contains one IPv6 address
only.
Select Range Address if this object contains several IPv6s
within a range.
Select Subnet Address if this object contains one subnet for
IPv6 address.
Select Any Address if this object contains any IPv6 address.
Select Mac Address if this object contains Mac address.
Mac Address Type the MAC address of the network card which will be
controlled.
Start IP Address Type the start IP address for Single Address type.
End IP Address Type the end IP address if the Range Address type is
selected.
Prefix Length Type the number (e.g., 64) for the prefix length of IPv6
address.
Invert Selection If it is checked, all the IPv6 addresses except the ones listed
above will be applied later while it is chosen.
3. After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the group profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile. Maximum 15 characters are
allowed.
Available IPv6 All the available IPv6 objects with the specified interface
Objects chosen above will be shown in this box.
Selected IPv6 Objects Click >> button to add the selected IPv6 objects in this box.
3. After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the object profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile. Maximum 15 characters are
allowed.
Protocol Specify the protocol(s) which this profile will apply to.
Source/Destination Source Port and the Destination Port columns are available
Port for TCP/UDP protocol. It can be ignored for other protocols.
The filter rule will filter out any port number.
(=) – when the first and last value are the same, it indicates
one port; when the first and last values are different, it
indicates a range for the port and available for this profile.
(!=) – when the first and last value are the same, it
indicates all the ports except the port defined
here; when the first and last values are different, it
indicates that all the ports except the range defined here are
available for this service type.
(>) – the port number greater than this value is available.
(<) – the port number less than this value is available for this
profile.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the group profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile. Maximum 15 characters are
allowed.
Available Service All the available service objects that you have added on
Type Objects Objects Setting>>Service Type Object will be shown in this
box.
Selected Service Type Click >> button to add the selected IP objects in this box.
Objects
3. After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the object profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this profile, e.g., game. Maximum 15
characters are allowed.
Contents Type the content for such profile. For example, type
gambling as Contents. When you browse the webpage, the
page with gambling information will be watched out and be
passed/blocked based on the configuration on Firewall
settings.
3. After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the group profile.
Item Description
Name Type a name for this group. Maximum 15 characters are
allowed.
Available Keyword You can gather keyword objects from Keyword Object page
Objects within one keyword group. All the available Keyword
objects that you have created will be shown in this box.
Selected Keyword
Objects Click button to add the selected Keyword objects in
this box.
3. After finishing all the settings, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all profiles.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Name Display the name of the object profile.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for this profile. The maximum length of the
name you can set is 7 characters.
3. Type a name for such profile and check all the items of file extension that will be
processed in the router. Finally, click OK to save this profile.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all of the settings and return to factory default
settings.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Profile Display the name for such SMS profile.
SMS Provider Display the service provider which offers SMS service.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for such SMS profile. The maximum length of
the name you can set is 31 characters.
Service Provider Use the drop down list to specify the service provider which
offers SMS service.
Username Type a user name that the sender can use to register to
selected SMS provider.
The maximum length of the name you can set is 31
characters.
Password Type a password that the sender can use to register to
selected SMS provider.
The maximum length of the password you can set is 31
characters.
Quota Type the number of the credit that you purchase from the
service provider chosen above.
Note that one credit equals to one SMS text message on the
standard route.
Sending Interval To avoid quota being exhausted soon, type time interval for
sending the SMS.
3. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
You can click the number (e.g., #9) under Index column for configuration in details.
Item Description
Profile Name Display the name of this profile. It cannot be modified.
Service Provider Type the website of the service provider.
Type the URL string in the box under the filed of Service
Provider. You have to contact your SMS provider to obtain
the exact URL string.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Set to Factory Default Clear all of the settings and return to factory default
settings.
Index Display the profile number that you can configure.
Profile Display the name for such mail server profile.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for such mail service profile. The maximum
length of the name you can set is 31 characters.
SMTP Server Type the IP address of the mail server.
SMTP Port Type the port number for SMTP server.
Sender Address Type the e-mail address of the sender.
Use SSL Check this box to use port 465 for SMTP server for some
e-mail server uses https as the transmission method.
Authentication The mail server must be authenticated with the correct
username and password to have the right of sending message
out. Check the box to enable the function.
Username – Type a name for authentication. The maximum
length of the name you can set is 31 characters.
Password – Type a password for authentication. The
maximum length of the password you can set is 31
characters.
3. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Profile Name Type a name for such notification profile. The maximum
length of the name you can set is 15 characters.
Category Display the types that will be monitored.
Status Display the status for the category. You can check the box to
be monitored.
For example, the check box of CPE firmware upgrade fail
under the category of Central VPN Management is checked.
Once such profile is enabled, Vigor router system will send
out notification to the recipient via SMS.
3. After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
Add Click it to open the following page for adding a new string
object.
Set to Factory Default Click it to clear all of the settings in this page.
Index Display the number link of the string profile.
String Display the string defined.
Clear Choose the string that you want to remove. Then click this
check box to delete the selected string.
A-1 How to Send a Notification to Specified Phone Number via SMS Service in
WAN Disconnection
Follow the steps listed below:
1. Log into the web user interface of Vigor router.
2. Configure relational objects first. Open Object Settings>>SMS/Mail Server Object to
get the following page.
Index 1 to Index 8 allows you to choose the built-in SMS service provider. If the SMS
service provider is not on the list, you can configure Index 9 and Index 10 to add the new
service provider to Vigor router.
3. Choose any index number (e.g., Index 1 in this case) to configure the SMS Provider
setting. In the following page, type the username and password and set the quota that
the router can send the message out.
6. Choose any index number (e.g., Index 1 in this case) to configure conditions for sending
the SMS. In the following page, type the name of the profile and check the Disconnected
and Reconnected boxes for WAN to work in concert with the topic of this paper.
8. Now, open Application >> SMS / Mail Alert Service. Use the drop down list to choose
SMS Provider and the Notify Profile (specify the time of sending SMS). Then, type the
phone number in the field of Recipient (the one who will receive the SMS).
9. Click OK to save the settings. Later, if one of the WAN connections fails in your router,
the system will send out SMS to the phone number specified. If the router has only one
WAN interface, the system will send out SMS to the phone number while reconnecting
the WAN interface successfully.
USB device connected on Vigor router can be regarded as a server or WAN interface. By way of
Vigor router, clients on LAN can access, write and read data stored in USB storage disk with
different applications. After setting the configuration in USB Application, you can type the IP
address of the Vigor router and username/password created in USB Application>>USB User
Management on the client software. Then, the client can use the FTP site (USB storage disk)
or share the SMB service through Vigor router.
Info USB ports on Vigor router are allowed to connect to USB modem. Models of
the modems supported by Vigor router can be seen from USB
Application>>Modem Support List. For network connection via USB
modem, refer to WAN>>Internet Access and WAN>>General Setup for
detailed information.
Item Description
General Settings Simultaneous FTP Connections - This field is used to specify
the quantity of the FTP sessions. The router allows up to 6
FTP sessions connecting to USB storage disk at one time.
Default Charset - At present, Vigor router supports four
types of character sets. Default Charset is for English based
file name.
After finishing all the settings here, please click OK to save the configuration.
Item Description
FTP/SMB User Enable – Click this button to activate this profile (account)
for FTP service or SMB User service. Later, the user can use
the username specified in this page to login into FTP server.
Disable – Click this button to disable such profile.
Username Type the username for FTP/SMB users for accessing into FTP
server (USB storage disk). Be aware that users cannot access
into USB storage disk in anonymity. Later, you can open FTP
client software and type the username specified here for
accessing into USB storage disk. The length of the name is
limited to 11 characters.
Note: “Admin” could not be typed here as username, for the
word is specified for accessing into web pages of Vigor router
only. Also, it is reserved for FTP firmware upgrade usage.
Note: FTP Passive mode is not supported by Vigor Router.
Please disable the mode on the FTP client.
Password Type the password for FTP/SMB users for accessing FTP
server. Later, you can open FTP client software and type the
password specified here for accessing into USB storage disk.
The length of the password is limited to 11 characters.
Confirm Password Type the password again to make confirmation.
Home Folder It determines the folder for the client to access into.
The user can enter a directory name in this field. Then, after
clicking OK, the router will create the specific/new folder in
the USB storage disk. In addition, if the user types “/” here,
he/she can access into all of the disk folders and files in USB
storage disk.
Note: When write protect status for the USB storage disk is
ON, you cannot type any new folder name in this field. Only
“/” can be used in such case.
Before you click OK, you have to insert a USB storage disk into the USB interface of the Vigor
router. Otherwise, you cannot save the configuration.
Item Description
Click this icon to refresh files list.
Refresh
Click this icon to return to the upper directory.
Back
Click this icon to add a new folder.
Create
Current Path Display current folder.
Item Description
Connection Status If there is no USB device connected to Vigor router, “No Disk
Connected” will be shown here.
Disk Capacity It displays the total capacity of the USB storage disk.
Free Capacity It displays the free space of the USB storage disk. Click
Refresh at any time to get new status for free capacity.
Index It displays the number of the client which connects to FTP
server.
IP Address It displays the IP address of the user’s host which connects to
the FTP server.
Username It displays the username that user uses to login to the FTP
server.
When you insert USB device into the Vigor router, the system will start to find out such device
within several seconds.
Item Description
Display Settings Temperature Calibration - Type a value used for
correcting the temperature error.
Temperature Unit - Choose the display unit of the
temperature. There are two types for you to choose.
Alarm Settings Enable Syslog Alarm - The temperature log will be
recorded on Syslog if it is enabled.
Upper temperature limit/Lower temperature limit - Type
the upper limit and lower limit for the system to send out
temperature alert.
Temperature Chart
Below shows an example of temperature graph:
A-1 How can I get the files from USB storage device connecting to Vigor
router?
Files on USB storage device can be reviewed by opening USB Applicaiton>>File Explorer. If it
is necessary for you to delete, copy files on the device or write, paste files to the devcie, it
must be done through SMB server or FTP server.
SMB service is based on the original USB FTP service. You will need to setup USB FTP first. We
would like to give brief instructions on USB FTP setup here.
1. Plug the USB device to the USB port on the router. Make sure Disk Connected appears on
the Connection Status as the figure shown below:
2. Then, please open USB Application >> USB General Settings to enable SMB service.
5. Make sure the FTP service is running properly. Please open a browser and type
ftp://192.168.1.1. Use the account "user1" to login.
7. Return to USB Application >> USB Disk Status. The information for FTP server will be
shown as below.
Now, users in LAN of Vigor2860 can access into the USB storage device by typing
ftp://192.168.1.1 on any browser. They can add or remove files / directories,
depending on the Access Rule for FTP account settings in USB Application >>USB User
Management.
This section will guide you to solve abnormal situations if you cannot access into the Internet
after installing the router and finishing the web configuration. Please follow sections below to
check your basic installation status stage by stage.
Checking if the hardware status is OK or not.
Checking if the network connection settings on your computer are OK or not.
Pinging the router from your computer.
Checking if the ISP settings are OK or not.
Backing to factory default setting if necessary.
If all above stages are done and the router still cannot run normally, it is the time for you to
contact your dealer or DrayTek technical support for advanced help.
Item Description
Decoded Format It shows the source IP address (local), destination IP
(remote) address, the protocol and length of the package.
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
Item Description
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
Item Description
Show Specify LAN and VLAN to display related information.
In default, this page will display all of the information
about LAN and VLAN.
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
Item Description
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
Item Description
Index It displays the connection item number.
IP Address It displays the IP address assigned by this router for specified
PC.
MAC Address It displays the MAC address for the specified PC that DHCP
assigned IP address for it.
Leased Time It displays the leased time of the specified PC.
HOST ID It displays the host ID name of the specified PC.
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
Item Description
Private IP:Port It indicates the source IP address and port of local PC.
#Pseudo Port It indicates the temporary port of the router used for NAT.
Peer IP:Port It indicates the destination IP address and port of remote
host.
Interface It displays the representing number for different interface.
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
Item Description
Clear Click this link to remove the result on the window.
Refresh Click it to reload the page.
When an entry’s TTL is Check the box the type the value of TTL (time to live) for
larger than…. each entry. Click OK to enable such function.
It means when the TTL value of each DNS query reaches the
threshold of the value specified here, the corresponding
record will be deleted from router’s Cache automatically.
or
Item Description
IPV4 /IPV6 Choose the interface for such function.
Ping through Use the drop down list to choose the WAN/LTE interface that
you want to ping through or choose Unspecified to be
determined by the router automatically.
Ping to Use the drop down list to choose the destination that you
want to ping.
Click Diagnostics and click Data Flow Monitor to open the web page. You can click IP Address,
TX rate, RX rate or Session link for arranging the data display.
Item Description
Enable Data Flow Monitor Check this box to enable this function.
Refresh Seconds Use the drop down list to choose the time interval of
refreshing data flow that will be done by the system
automatically.
APP QoS Use the drop down list to change the priority in data
transmission for the specified IP address (host).
Current /Peak/Speed Current means current transmission rate and receiving rate
for WAN interface.
Peak means the highest peak value detected by the router in
The horizontal axis represents time. Yet the vertical axis has different meanings. For
WAN1/WAN2/WAN3/LTE/WAN4 Bandwidth chart, the numbers displayed on vertical axis
represent the numbers of the transmitted and received packets in the past.
For Sessions chart, the numbers displayed on vertical axis represent the numbers of the NAT
sessions during the past.
or
Item Description
IPv4 / IPv6 Click one of them to display corresponding information for it.
Trace through Use the drop down list to choose the interface that you want
to ping through.
Item Description
Enable Web Syslog Check this box to enable the function of Web Syslog.
Syslog Type Use the drop down list to specify a type of Syslog to be
displayed.
Item Description
Time Display the time of the event occurred.
Log Type Display the type of the record.
Message Display the information for each event.
Item Description
Refresh Click this link to refresh this page manually.
Item Description
Info The icon - - means there is something wrong (e.g., attacking the
system) with that IP address.
Item Description
Blocking IP Type the IP address in this field and click add. It will be added
to the IP List and appear in the right frame.
IP list in the right frame will be blocked by Vigor system
permanatly.
Remove – It is used to remove selected IP address from the
Blocking IP List.
Refresh Click this link to refresh current page.
3. If not, it means that there is something wrong with the hardware status. Simply back to
“I-2 Hardware Installation” to execute the hardware installation again. And then, try
again.
Sometimes the link failure occurs due to the wrong network connection settings. After trying
the above section, if the link is stilled failed, please do the steps listed below to make sure
the network connection settings is OK.
For Windows
Info The example is based on Windows 7. As to the examples for other operation
systems, please refer to the similar steps or find support notes in
www.DrayTek.com.
3. Icons of network connection will be shown on the window. Right-click on Local Area
Connection and click on Properties.
The default gateway IP address of the router is 192.168.1.1. For some reason, you might need
to use “ping” command to check the link status of the router. The most important thing is
that the computer will receive a reply from 192.168.1.1. If not, please check the IP
address of your computer. We suggest you setting the network connection as get IP
automatically. (Please refer to the previous section IX-3)
Please follow the steps below to ping the router correctly.
For Windows
1. Open the Command Prompt window (from Start menu> Run).
2. Type command (for Windows 95/98/ME) or cmd (for Windows NT/ 2000/XP/Vista/7).
The DOS command dialog will appear.
3. Type ping 192.168.1.1 and press [Enter]. If the link is OK, the line of “Reply from
192.168.1.1:bytes=32 time<1ms TTL=255” will appear.
4. If the line does not appear, please check the IP address setting of your computer.
If WAN connection cannot be up, check if the LEDs (according to the LED explanations listed
on section 1.2) are correct or not. If the LEDs are off, please:
Change the Physical Type from Auto negotiation to other values (e.g., 100M full duplex).
Next, change the physical type of modem (e.g., DSL/FTTX(GPON)/Cable modem) offered
by ISP with the same value configured in Vigor router. Check if the LEDs on Vigor router
are on or not.
If not, please install an additional switch for connecting both Vigor router and the modem
offered by ISP. Then, check if the LEDs on Vigor router are on or not.
If the problem of LEDs cannot be solved by the above measures, please contact with the
nearest reseller, or send an e-mail to DrayTek FAE for technical support.
Check if the settings offered by ISP are configured well or not.
When the LEDs are on and correct, yet the WAN connection still cannot be up, please:
Open WAN >> Internet Access page and then check whether the ISP settings are set
correctly. Click Details Page of WAN1~WAN4 to review the settings that you configured
previously.
When you have trouble in using 3G/4G network transmission, please check the following:
USB LED lights on but the network connection does not work
Check the PIN Code of SIM card is disabled or not. Please use the utility of 3G/4G USB Modem
to disable PIN code and try again. If it still fails, it might be the compliance problem of system.
Please open DrayTek Syslog Tool to capture the connection information (WAN Log) and send
the page (similar to the following graphic) to the service center of DrayTek.
Sometimes, a wrong connection can be improved by returning to the default settings. Try to
reset the router by software or hardware. Such function is available in Admin Mode only.
Info After pressing factory default setting, you will loose all settings you did
before. Make sure you have recorded all useful settings before you pressing.
The password of factory default is null.
Software Reset
You can reset the router to factory default via Web page. Such function is available in Admin
Mode only.
Go to System Maintenance and choose Reboot System on the web page. The following screen
will appear. Choose Using factory default configuration and click Reboot Now. After few
seconds, the router will return all the settings to the factory settings.
Hardware Reset
While the router is running (ACT LED blinking), press the Factory Reset button and hold for
more than 5 seconds. When you see the ACT LED blinks rapidly, please release the button.
Then, the router will restart with the default configuration.
If the router still cannot work correctly after trying many efforts, please contact your dealer
for further help right away. For any questions, please feel free to send e-mail to
[email protected].
Virtual Local Area Network is so-called VLAN. It offers the logical grouping technique to
separate the physical ports of Ethernet switches, thus we can manage our local network
easier, more flexible and secure. For instance, you’re a networking administrator in your
company and you’re planning to isolate the visitors’ traffics from your private network for
security considerations because you cannot ensure that visitors’ computer is clean. Or you
want to separate your private network into several parts by divisions because there are too
many computers in the same network segment and it results in the local traffics heavily.
VLAN helps you to solve these situations, and DrayTek’s products support bellow two popular
types:
Port-based
It uses a matrix table of the physical ports to define the traffics how to exchange between
each port, and the traffics will be isolated from the ports are not being ticked in the same
line. It is the easiest way to setup an isolate network, but not a flexible way to maintain a
growing network. Because the idea of port-based VLAN is grouping by physical ports, but the
difficulty is how to handle the traffics between two or more Ethernet switches. Thus, VLAN is
suitable for some circumstances, for example, the rental apartment, SOHO office…and so on.
These clients may need two or three isolated networks only and setup a network in a simple
way.
Tag-based
The idea of tag-based VLAN is to identify a virtual LAN with a specific ID, therefore, VLAN ID
introduced by tag-based VLAN. Through VLAN ID, ports with different VID (VLAN ID) will be
identified as in different LANs, so the traffics also will be isolated from each of VLANs. Many
administrators who manage an enterprise network or even the internet service providers (ISP)
adopt Tag-based VLAN popularly because it is convenient to maintain and manage a
distributed network. Setting a large-scale network is easy by giving each of them with
different VID and isolating the traffics at the same time. Besides the VLAN ID, there is another
feature, Trunk, introduced. While the role of a port on an Ethernet switch is setup as a Trunk
port, it means the VLAN ID will be kept while forwarding the packets between switches. By
this feature, VLANs are able to distribute over two or more Ethernet switches easily,
moreover design a large and secured network is possible through Trunk port. When VLAN is
being enabled on Vigor routers, the LAN ports are being turned into Trunk mode automatically.
Therefore, a VLAN supported switch, like VigorSwitch G2260/P2261, or VigorSwitch G1240, is
needed.
Trunk Port can carry the packets with VID but replace the Non-VID packet as the VID of Trunk
port while forwarding the packets to another switch.
Bridge mode of WAN
P1 and P2 are doing NAT flow to access to the internet, but P3 and P4 will forward the packets
between WAN and LAN ports directly.
Tag-based mode
By above settings, there are four private networks will be created and computers attached
with each of LAN ports or SSIDs which are able to obtain a private IP address from each
DHCP server (LAN1/LAN2/LAN3/LAN4). However, the traffics of the LAN port or SSID that
are NOT being grouped in the same VLAN are unable to forward to each other. The benefit
of Port-based is able to extend the wired ports by installing a cheaper dumb switch as
many as you need, but Tag-based offers you a flexible and well-managed network. The
networks are isolated, secured and reduce the broadcasting storm effectively in each of
networks with VLAN.
Guest Network
Tag-based mode
To deploy a guest network, which serves your guests the internet accessibility, but the
traffics have to be isolated from your private network due to the security considerations,
it can be done by above settings. However, a switch support VLAN function is need if VLAN
Tag enabled.
Triple Play (Multi-WAN)
NAT mode with VLAN
Following settings, the set-top box (STB) is able to attach with any LAN port. Video
streaming which your ISP provided will be played on your monitor.
Set-top box (STB) or the other kinds of media devices are able to attach with Port4 or
Port5 of LAN. Those devices that attached with Port4 or Port5 are able to access the
services network directly which your ISP provided.
This chapter also gives you a general description for accessing telnet and describes the
firmware versions for the routers explained in this manual.
Info For Windows 7 user, please make sure the Windows Features of Telnet
Client has been turned on under Control Panel>>Programs.
Type cmd and press Enter. The Telnet terminal will be open later.
In the following window, type Telnet 192.168.1.1 as below and press Enter. Note that the IP
address in the example is the default address of the router. If you have changed the default,
enter the current IP address of the router.
Next, type admin/admin for Account/Password. Then, type ?. You will see a list of
valid/common commands depending on the router that your use.
Syntax
adsl txpct [auto:percent]
adsl rxpct [auto:percent]
Parameter Description
auto It means auto detection of ADSL transmission packet.
percent Specify the percentage of ADSL transmission packet.
Available range is 10-100.
Example
> adsl txpct auto
% tx percentage : 80
> adsl txpct 75
% tx percentage : 75
Syntax
adsl status [more | counts | hlog | qln | snr | bandinfo | olr]
Example
> adsl status
--------------------------- ATU-R Info (hw: annex A, f/w: annex Unknown) -----
Running Mode : T1.413 State : TRAINING
DS Actual Rate : 0 bps US Actual Rate : 0 bps
DS Attainable Rate : 0 bps US Attainable Rate: 0 bps
DS Path Mode : Fast US Path Mode : Fast
DS Interleave Depth : 0 US Interleave Depth: 0
NE Current Attenuation : 0 dB Cur SNR Margin : 0 dB
DS actual PSD : 0. 0 dB US actual PSD : 0. 0 dB
ADSL Firmware Version : 05-04-08-00-00-06
--------------------------- ATU-C Info ---------------------------------
Far Current Attenuation : 0 dB Far SNR Margin : 0 dB
CO ITU Version[0] : 00000000 CO ITU Version[1] : 00000000
DSLAM CHIPSET VENDOR : < ADI >
>
Syntax
adsl ppp [ ? | pvc_no vci vpi Encap Proto modu acqIP idle [Username Password]
Syntax Description
You have to reboot the system when you set it on Route mode.
Example
Syntax
adsl bridge [pvc_no/status/save/enable/disable] [on/off/clear/tag tag_no] [service type]
[px ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Example
> adsl bridge 4 on p2 p3
PVC Bridge p1 p2 p3 p4 Service Type Tag Pri
------------------------------------------------------------
4 ON 0 0 1 0 Normal -1(OFF) 0
PVC 0 & 1 can't set for bridge mode.
Please use 'save' to save config.
Syntax
adsl idle [on | tcpmessage | tcpmessage_off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on DSL is under test mode.
DSL debug tool mode is off.
tcpmessage DSL debug tool mode is on.
tcpmessage_off DSL debug tool mode is off.
Example
> adsl idle on
% DSL is under [IDLE/QUIET] test mode.
% DSL debug tool mode is off.
> adsl idle tcpmessage
% Set DSL debug tool mode on. Please reboot system to take effect.
Example
> adsl reboot
% Adsl is Rebooting...
Syntax
adsl oamlb [n][type]
adsl oamlb chklink [on/off]
adsl oamlb [log_on/log_off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
n It means the total number of transmitted packets.
type It means the protocol that you can use.
1 – for F4 Seg-to-Seg (VP level)
2 – for F4 End-to-End (VP level)
4 – for F5 Seg-to-Seg (VC level)
5 – for F5 End-to-End (VC level)
chklink Check the DSL connection.
Log_on/log_off Enable or disable the OAM log for debug.
Example
> adsl oamlb chklink on
OAM checking dsl link is ON.
> adsl oamlb F5 4
Tx cnt=0
Rx Cnt=0
>
Syntax
adsl vcilimit [n]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
n The number shall be between 1 ~ 254.
Example
> adsl vcilimit 33
change VCI limitation from 32 to 33.
Example
> adsl annex
% hardware is annex B.
% modem code is annex B; built at 01/15,07:34.
Syntax
adsl automode [add|remove|set|default|show] [adsl_mode]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
add It means to add ADSL mode.
remove It means to remove ADSL mode.
set It means to use default settings plus the new added ADSL mode.
default It means to use default settings.
show It means to display current setting.
adsl_mode There are three modes to be choose, ANNEXL, ANNEXM (annexA:
ADSL over POTS) and ANNEXJ (annexB: ADSL over ISDN).
Example
> adsl automode set ANNEXJ
Automode supported : T1.413, G.DMT, ADSL2, ADSL2+, ANNEXJ,
Syntax
adsl showbins [startbin endbin | up]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
startbin The number is between 0 ~ 4092.
endbin The number is between 4 ~ 4095.
up Show upstream information.
Example
> adsl showbins 2 30
DOWNSTREAM :
Syntax
adsl optn FUNC [us/ds/bi [value/on/off]]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
FUNC Available settings contain:
'bitswap',
'sra',
'aelem',
'g.vector',
'status',
'trellis',
'retx',
'default'.
us/ds/bi us: upstream
ds: downstream
bi: bidirection.
'aelem' and 'g.vector' can be only on/off.
value The value shall be hex digits.
bitswap=0~2,
sra=0,2,3,4.
on/off Type “on” for enabling such function.
Type “off” for disabling such function.
Example
> adsl optn default
trellis [US] = ON, [DS] = ON.
bitswap [US] = 0, [DS] = 0.
[0: default(ON), 1: ON, 2: OFF]
sra [US] = 0, [DS] = 0.
[0: default(=3), 2: OFF, 3: ON , 4: DYNAMIC_SOS]
retx [US] = ON, [DS] = ON.
aelem ON
G.Vector ON
Example
> adsl savecfg
% Xdsl Cfg Save OK!
Syntax
adsl vendorid [status/on/off/ set vid0 vid1]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
status Display current status of user-defined vendor ID.
on Enable the user-defined function.
off Disable the user-defined function.
set vid0 vid1 It means to set user-defined vendor ID with vid0 and vid1.
The vendor ID shall be set with HEX format, ex: 00fe7244: 79612f21.
Example
> adsl vendorid status
% User define CPE Vendor ID is OFF
% vid0:vid1 = 0x00fe7244:79612f21
> adsl vendorid on set vid0 vid1
% User define CPE Vendor ID is ON
Syntax
adsl atm pcr [pvc_no][PCR][max][status]
adsl atm scr [pvc_no][SCR]
adsl atm mbs [pvc_no][MBS]
adsl atm status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
pvc_no It means pvc number and must be between 0(Channel 1) to
7(Channel 8).
PCR It means Peak Cell Rate for upstream.
The range for the number is “1” to “2539”.
max It means to get the highest speed for the upstream.
SCR It means Sustainable Cell Rate.
MBS It means Maximum Burst Size.
status It means to display PCR/SCR/MBS setting.
Example
> adsl atm pcr 1 200 max
% PCR is 200 for pvc 1.
Syntax
adsl pvcbinding [pvc_x pvc_y | status | -1 ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
pvc_x It means the PVC number for the source.
pvc_y It means the PVC number that the source PVC will be bound to.
status Display a table for PVC binding group.
-1 It means to clear specific PVC binding.
Example
> adsl pvcbinding 3 5
set done. bind pvc3 to pvc5.
The above example means the PVC3 binding group has been removed.
Syntax
adsl inventory [co|cpe]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
co It means DSLAM (Digital Subscriber Line Access Multiplexer) or CO
(Central Office).
cpe It means CPE (Customer Premise Equipment).
Example
> adsl inventory co
xDSL inventory info only available in showtime.
Syntax
vdsl status [more | counts | hlog | qln | snr | bandinfo | olr]
Example
> vdsl status
---------------------- ATU-R Info (hw: annex A, f/w: annex A/B/C) -----------
Running Mode : State : TRAINING
DS Actual Rate : 0 bps US Actual Rate : 0 bps
DS Attainable Rate : 0 bps US Attainable Rate : 0 bps
DS Path Mode : Fast US Path Mode : Fast
DS Interleave Depth : 0 US Interleave Depth : 0
NE Current Attenuation : 0 dB Cur SNR Margin : 0 dB
DS actual PSD : 0. 0 dB US actual PSD : 0. 0 dB
NE CRC Count : 0 FE CRC Count : 0
NE ES Count : 0 FE ES Count : 0
Xdsl Reset Times : 0 Xdsl Link Times : 0
ITU Version[0] : b5004946 ITU Version[1] : 544e0000
VDSL Firmware Version : 05-04-08-00-00-06
Power Management Mode : DSL_G997_PMS_NA
Test Mode : DISABLE
---------------------- ATU-C Info ---------------------------------
Far Current Attenuation : 0 dB Far SNR Margin : 0 dB
CO ITU Version[0] : 00000000 CO ITU Version[1] : 00000000
DSLAM CHIPSET VENDOR : < unknown >
>
Syntax
vdsl idle [on | tcpmessage | tcpmessage_off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on DSL is under test mode.
DSL debug tool mode is off.
Example
> vdsl idle on
% DSL is under [IDLE/QUIET] test mode.
% DSL debug tool mode is off.
> vdsl idle tcpmessage
% Set DSL debug tool mode on. Please reboot system to take effect.
Example
> vdsl reboot
% Adsl is Rebooting...
Example
> vdsl annex
% hardware is annex A.
% ADSL modem code is annex A
Syntax
vdsl showbins [startbin endbin | up]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
startbin The number is between 0 ~ 4092.
endbin The number is between 4 ~ 4095.
up Show upstream information.
Example
Syntax
vdsl optn FUNC [us/ds/bi [value/on/off]]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
FUNC Available settings contain:
'bitswap',
'sra',
'aelem',
'g.vector',
'status',
'trellis',
'retx',
'default'.
us/ds/bi us: upstream
ds: downstream
bi: bidirection.
'aelem' and 'g.vector' can be only on/off.
value The value shall be hex digits.
bitswap=0~2,
sra=0,2,3,4.
on/off Type “on” for enabling such function.
Type “off” for disabling such function.
Example
> vdsl optn default
trellis [US] = ON, [DS] = ON.
bitswap [US] = 0, [DS] = 0.
[0: default(ON), 1: ON, 2: OFF]
sra [US] = 0, [DS] = 0.
[0: default(=3), 2: OFF, 3: ON , 4: DYNAMIC_SOS]
retx [US] = ON, [DS] = ON.
aelem ON
G.Vector ON
Example
> vdsl savecfg
% Xdsl Cfg Save OK!
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
status Display current status of user-defined vendor ID.
on Enable the user-defined function.
off Disable the user-defined function.
set vid0 vid1 It means to set user-defined vendor ID with vid0 and vid1.
The vendor ID shall be set with HEX format, ex: 00fe7244: 79612f21.
Example
> vdsl vendorid status
% User define CPE Vendor ID is OFF
% vid0:vid1 = 0x00fe7244:79612f21
> vdsl vendorid on set vid0 vid1
% User define CPE Vendor ID is ON
Syntax
vdsl inventory [co|cpe]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
co It means DSLAM (Digital Subscriber Line Access Multiplexer) or CO
(Central Office).
cpe It means CPE (Customer Premise Equipment).
Example
> vdsl inventory co
xDSL inventory info only available in showtime.
> vdsl inventory cpe
G.994 vendor ID : 0XB5004946544E5444
G.994.1 country code : 0XB500
G.994.1 provider code : IFTN
G.994.1 vendor info : 0X5444
System vendor ID : 0XB5004946544E0000
System country code : 0XB500
System provider code : IFTN
System vendor info : 0X000
Version number : 3.8.2_RC4a_STD
Version number(16 octets) : 0X332E382E325F524334615F5354440000
Self-test result : PASS
Transmission mode capability : 0X40004004C010400
>
Syntax
bpa m [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
m Available settings are 1 and 2.
-a <enable> 1/0 to enable/disable this entry
-n <UserName> contact UserName(max. 24 characters)
-p <PassWord> contact PassWord (max. 24 characters)
-s <select> It means to specify an IP address for Server.
0 : no selection.
1 : NSW(61.9.192.13)
2 : QLD(61.9.208.13),
3 : VIC(61.9.128.13)
4 : SA(61.9.224.13),
5 : WA(61.9.240.13)
-l <List> List all settings configured.
Example
> bpa 1 -a 1 -n testUser -p testPassword -s 4
> bpa -l
-------index: 1 active------
UserName[1]: testUser
PassWord[1]: testPassword
ServerIP[1]:4
-------index: 2 inactive------
UserName[2]:
PassWord[2]:
ServerIP[2]:0
>
Syntax
csm appe prof -i INDEX [-v | -n NAME|setdefault]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
INDEX It means to specify the index number of CSM profile, from 1 to 32.
-v It means to view the configuration of the CSM profile.
-n It means to set a name for the CSM profile.
NAME It means to specify a name for the CSM profile, less then 15
characters.
setdefault Reset to default settings.
Example
> csm appe prof -i 1 -n games
The name of APPE Profile 1 was setted.
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
INDEX Specify the index number of CSM profile, from 1 to 32.
-v View the IM/P2P/Protocol and Others configuration of the CSM
profile.
-e Enable to block specific application.
-d Disable to block specific application.
-a Set the action of specific application
GROUP Specify the category of the application. Available options are: IM,
P2P, Protocol and Others.
AP_IDX Each application has independent index number for identification in
CLI command.
Specify the index number of the application here. If you have no
idea of the inex number, do the following (Take IM as an example):
Type “csm appe set –I 1 –v IM”, the system will list all of the index
numbers of the applications categorized under IM.
ACTION Specify the action of the application, 0 or 1.
0: Block. All of the applications meet the CSM rule will be blocked.
1: Pass. All of the applications meet the CSM rule will be passed.
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-a View the configuration status for All groups.
-i View the configuration status of IM group.
-p View the configuration status of P2P group.
-t View the configuration status of protocol group.
-m View the configuration status of Others group.
Example
>csm appe show -t
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
INDEX Specify the index number of CSM profile, from 1 to 32.
-i View the configuration status of IM group.
-p View the configuration status of P2P group.
-t View the configuration status of protocol group.
-m View the configuration status of Others group.
Example
> csm appe config -v 1 -m
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
AUTO Vigor router specifies WAN interface automatically.
WAN Specify the WAN interface for signature downloading.
Example
> csm appe interface wan1
Download interface is set as "WAN1" now.
> csm appe interface auto
Download interface is set as "auto-selected" now.
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-e Enable notification e-mail mechanism.
-d Disable notification e-mail mechanism.
-s Send an example e-mail.
Example
> csm appe email -e
Enable APPE email.
Syntax
csm ucf show
csm ucf setdefault
csm ucf msg MSG
csm ucf obj INDEX [-n PROFILE_NAME | -l [P|B|A|N] | uac | wf ]
csm ucf obj INDEX -n PROFILE_NAME
csm ucf obj INDEX -p VALUE
csm ucf obj INDEX -l P|B|A|N
csm ucf obj INDEX uac
csm ucf obj INDEX wf
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show It means to display all of the profiles.
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all of the profile.
msg MSG It means de set the administration message.
MSG means the content (less than 255 characters) of the message
itself.
obj It means to specify the object for the profile.
INDEX It means to specify the index number of CSM profile, from 1 to 8.
-n It means to set the profile name.
PROFILE_NAME It means to specify the name of the profile (less than 16 characters)
-p Set the priority (defined by the number specified in VALUE) for the
profile.
Example
> csm ucf obj 1 -n game -l B
Profile Index: 1
Profile Name:[game]
Log:[none]
Priority Select : [Bundle : Pass]
Syntax
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -v
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -e
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -d
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -a P|B
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -i E|D
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -o KEY_WORD_Object_Index
csm ucf obj INDEX uac -g KEY_WORD_Group_Index
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
INDEX It means to specify the index number of CSM profile, from 1 to 8.
Example
> csm ucf obj 1 uac -i E
Profile Index: 1
Profile Name:[game]
Log:[none]
Priority Select : [Bundle : Pass]
Syntax
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -v
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -e
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -d
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -a P|B
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -s WEB_FEATURE
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -u WEB_FEATURE
csm ucf obj INDEX wf -f File_Extension_Object_index
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
INDEX It means to specify the index number of CSM profile, from 1 to 8.
-v It means to view the protocol configuration of the CSM profile.
-e It means to enable the restriction of web feature.
-d It means to disable the restriction of web feature.
-a Set the action of web feature, P or B.
B: Block. The web access meets the web feature will be blocked.
P: Pass. The web access meets the web feature will be passed.
-s It means to enable the the Web Feature configuration.
Features available for configuration are:
c: Cookie
p: Proxy
u: Upload
-u It means to cancel the web feature configuration.
-f It means to set the file extension object index number.
File_Extension_Object_inde Type the index number (1 to 8) for the file extension object.
x
Example
> csm ucf obj 1 wf -s c
Profile Index: 1
Profile Name:[game]
Log:[none]
Priority Select : [Bundle : Pass]
Syntax
csm wcf show
csm wcf look
csm wcf cache
csm wcf server WCF_SERVER
csm wcf msg MSG
csm wcf setdefault
csm wcf obj INDEX -v
csm wcf obj INDEX -a P|B
csm wcf obj INDEX -n PROFILE_NAME
csm wcf obj INDEX -l N|P|B|A
csm wcf obj INDEX -o KEY_WORD Object Index
csm wcf obj INDEX -g KEY_WORD Group Index
csm wcf obj INDEX -w E|D|P|B
csm wcf obj INDEX -s CATEGORY|WEB_GROUP
csm wcf obj INDEX -u CATEGORY|WEB_GROUP
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show It means to display the web content filter profiles.
Look It means to display the license information of WCF.
Cache It means to set the cache level for the profile.
Server WCF_SERVER It means to set web content filter server.
Msg MSG It means de set the administration message.
MSG means the content (less than 255 characters) of the message
itself.
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all of the profile.
obj It means to specify the object profile.
INDEX It means to specify the index number of web content filter profile,
from 1 to 8.
-v It means to view the web content filter profile.
-a Set the action of web content filter profile, P or B.
B: Block. The web access meets the web feature will be blocked.
P: Pass. The web access meets the web feature will be passed.
-n It means to set the profile name.
PROFILE_NAME It means to specify the name of the profile (less than 16 characters)
-l It means the log type of the profile. They are:
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable Enable or disable DNS Filter.
ON: enable.
OFF: disable.
syslog Determine the content of records transmitting to Syslog.
P: Pass. Records for the packets passing through DNS filter will be
sent to Syslog.
B: Block. Records for the packets blocked by DNS filter will be
sent to Syslog.
A: All. Records for the packets passing through or blocked by DNS
filter will be sent to Syslog.
N: None. No record will be sent to Syslog.
service WCF_PROFILE WCF_PROFILE: Specify a WCF profile as the base of DNS filtering.
Type a number to indicate the index number of WCF profile (1 is
first profile, 2 is second profile, and so on ...).
time CACHE_TIME CACHE_TIME: It means to set the time for cache to live (available
values are 1 to 24; 1 is one hour, 2 is two hours, and so on ...) for
DNS filter.
blockpage DNS sends block page for redirect port. When a web page is
blocked by DNS filter, the router system will send a message page
to describe that the page is not allowed to be visisted.
ON: Enable the function of displaying message page.
OFF: Disable the function of displaying message page.
SHOW: Display the function of displaying message page is ON or
OFF.
profile_show Display the table of the DNS filter profile.
profile_edit Modify the content of the DNS filter profile.
-n PROFILE_NAME PROFILE_NAME: Type the name of the DNS filter profile that you
want to modify.
-l N|P|B|A Specify the log type of the profile.
P: Pass.
B: Block.
A: All.
N: None.
-w WCF_PROFILE WCF_PROFILE: Type the index number of the WCF profile.
-u UCF_PROFILE UCF_PROFILE: Type the index number of the UCF profile.
-c CACHE_TIME -c means to set the cache time for DNS filter.
CACHE_TIME: It means to set the time for cache to live (available
values are 1 to 24; 1 is one hour, 2 is two hours, and so on ...) for
DNS filter.
Example
> csm dnsf service 2
dns service set up!!!
>csm dnsf service 3
wcf profile 3 is empty.....
>csm dnsf cachetime 1
dns cache time set up!!!
Example
>ddns log
>
Syntax
ddns time <update in minutes>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Update in minutes Type the value as DDNS time. The range is from 1 to 14400.
Example
> ddns time
ddns time <update in minutes>
Valid: 1 ~ 1440
%Now: 1440
> ddns time 1000
ddns time <update in minutes>
Valid: 1 ~ 1440
%Now: 1000
Syntax
dos [-V | D | A]
dos [-s ATTACK_F [THRESHOLD][ TIMEOUT]]
dos [-a | e [ATTACK_F][ATTACK_0] | d [ATTACK_F][ATTACK_0]]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-V It means to view the configuration of DoS defense system.
-D It means to deactivate the DoS defense system.
-A It means to activate the DoS defense system.
-s It means to enable the defense function for a specific attack and set
its parameter(s).
ATTACK_F It means to specify the name of flooding attack(s) or portscan, e.g.,
synflood, udpflood, icmpflood, or postscan.
THRESHOLD It means the packet rate (packet/second) that a flooding attack will
be detected. Set a value larger than 20.
Example
>dos –A
The Dos Defense system is Activated
>dos –s synflood 50 10
Synflood is enabled! Threshold=50 <pke/sec> timeout=10 <pke/sec>
Syntax
internet -W n -M n [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-M n M means to set Internet Access Mode (Mandatory) and n means
different modes (represented by 0 – 3)
n=0: Offline
n=1: PPPoE
n=2: Dynamic IP
n=3: Static IP
<command><parameter>|…] The available commands with parameters are listed below.
[…] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-S <isp name> It means to set ISP Name (max. 23 characters).
-P <on/off> It means to enable PPPoE Service.
-u <username> It means to set username (max. 49 characters) for Internet
accessing.
-p <password> It means to set password (max. 49 characters) for Internet
accessing.
-a n It means to set PPP Authentication Type and n means different
types (represented by 0-1).
n=0: PAP/CHAP (this is default setting)
n=1: PAP Only
-t n It means to set connection duration and n means different
conditions.
Example
>internet -M 1 -S tcom -u username -p password -a 0 -t -1 -i 0.0.0.0
WAN1 Internet Mode set to PPPoE/PPPoA
Syntax
ip 2ndsubnet <Enable/Disable>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Enable Enable the function.
Disable Disable the function.
Example
> ip 2ndsubnet enable
2nd subnet enabled!
Syntax
ip pubaddr ?
ip pubaddr <public subnet IP address>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? Display an IP address which allows users set as the public subnet IP
address.
public subnet IP address Specify an IP address. The system will set the one that you specified
as the public subnet IP address.
Example
> ip pubaddr ?
% ip addr <public subnet IP address>
Syntax
ip pubmask ?
ip pubmask <public subnet mask>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? Display an IP address which allows users set as the public subnet
mask.
public subnet IP address Specify a subnet mask. The system will set the one that you
specified as the public subnet mask.
Example
> ip pubmask ?
% ip pubmask <public subnet mask>
% Now: 255.255.255.0
Syntax
ip aux add [IP] [Join to NAT Pool][wanX]
ip aux remove [index]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
add It means to create a new WAN IP address.
remove It means to delete an existed WAN IP address.
IP It means the auxiliary WAN IP address.
Join to NAT Pool 0 (disable) or 1 (enable).
wanX Add or remove an address for WAN interface.
index Type the index number of the table displayed on your screen.
Example
> ip aux add 192.168.1.65 1
% 192.168.1.65 has added in index 2.
When you type ip aux?, the current auxiliary WAN IP Address table will be shown as the
following:
Syntax
ip addr [IP address]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP address It means the LAN IP address.
Example
>ip addr 192.168.50.1
% Set IP address OK !!!
Info When the LAN IP address is changed, the start IP address of DHCP server are
still the same. To make the IP assignment of the DHCP server being
consistent with this new IP address (they should be in the same network
segment), the IP address of the PC must be fixed with the same LAN IP
address (network segment) set by this command for accessing into the web
user interface of the router. Later, modify the start addresses for the DHCP
server.
Syntax
ip nmask [IP netmask]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP netmask It means the netmask of LAN IP.
Example
> ip nmask 255.255.0.0
% Set IP netmask OK !!!
Syntax
ip arp add [IP address] [MAC address] [LAN or WAN]
ip arp del [IP address] [LAN or WAN]
ip arp flush
ip arp status
ip arp accept [0/1/2/3/4/5status]
ip arp setCacheLife [time]
In which, arp add allows users to add a new IP address into the ARP table; arp del allows users
to remove an IP address; arp flush allows users to clear arp cache; arp status allows users to
review current status for the arp table; arp accept allows to accept or reject the source
/destination MAC address; arp setCacheLife allows users to configure the duration in which
ARP caches can be stored on the system. If ip arp setCacheLife is set with “60”, it means you
have an ARP cache at 0 second. Sixty seconds later without any ARP messages received, the
system will think such ARP cache is expired. The system will issue a few ARP request to see if
this cache is still valid.
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP address It means the LAN IP address.
MAC address It means the MAC address of your router.
LAN or WAN It indicates the direction for the arp function.
0/1/2/3/4/5 0: disable to accept illegal source mac address
1: enable to accept illegal source mac address
2: disable to accept illegal dest mac address
3: enable to accept illegal dest mac address
4: Decline VRRP mac into arp table
5: Accept VRRP mac into arp table
status: display the setting status.
Time Available settings will be 10, 20, 30,....2550 seconds.
Syntax
ip dhcpc option
ip dhcpc option -h|l
ip dhcpc option -d [idx]
ip dhcpc option -e [1 or 0] -w [wan unmber] -c [option number] -v [option value]
ip dhcpc option -e [1 or 0] -w [wan unmber] -c [option number] -x "[option value]"
ip dhcpc option -u [idx unmber]
ip dhcpc release [wan number]
ip dhcpc renew [wan number]
ip dhcpc status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
option It is an optional setting for DHCP server.
-h: display usage
-l: list all custom set DHCP options
-d: delete custom dhcp client option by index number
-e: enable/disable option feature, 1:enable, 0:disable
-w: set WAN number (e.g., 1=WAN1)
-c: set option number: 0~255
-v: set option value by string
-x: set option value by raw byte (hex)
-u: update by index number
release It means to release current WAN IP address.
renew It means to renew the WAN IP address and obtain another new one.
status It displays current status of DHCP client.
Example
>ip dhcpc status
I/F#3 DHCP Client Status:
Syntax
ip ping [IP address] [WAN1 /PVC3/PVC4/PVC5]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP address It means the WAN IP address.
WAN1/PVC3/PVC4/PVC5 It means the WAN port /PVC that the above IP address passes
through.
Example
>ip ping 172.16.3.229 WAN1
Pinging 172.16.3.229 with 64 bytes of Data:
Receive reply from 172.16.3.229, time=0ms
Receive reply from 172.16.3.229, time=0ms
Receive reply from 172.16.3.229, time=0ms
Packets: Sent = 5, Received = 5, Lost = 0 <0% loss>
Syntax
ip tracert [Host/IP address] [WAN1/WAN2/WAN3/WAN4/WAN5] [Udp/Icmp]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP address It means the target IP address.
WAN1/WAN2 It means the WAN port that the above IP address passes through.
Udp/Icmp It means the UDP or ICMP.
Syntax
ip telnet [IP address][Port]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP address Type the WAN or LAN IP address of the remote device.
Port Type a port number (e.g., 23).
Available settings: 0 ~65535.
Example
> ip telnet 172.17.3.252 23
>
Syntax
ip rip [0/1/2]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
0/1/2 0 means disable; 1 means first subnet and 2 means second
subnet.
Example
> ip rip 1
%% Set RIP 1st subnet.
Syntax
ip wanrip [ifno] -e [0/1]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ifno It means the connection interface.
1: WAN1,2: WAN2, 3: PVC3,4: PVC4,5: PVC5
Note: PVC3 ~PVC5 are virtual WANs.
-e It means to disable or enable RIP setting for specified WAN
interface.
1: Enable the function of setting RIP of WAN IP.
0: Disable the function.
Example
> ip wanrip ?
Valid ex:ip wanrip <ifno> -e <0/1>
<ifno> 1: WAN1,2: WAN2
3: PVC3,4: PVC4,5: PVC5
-e <0/1> 0: disable, 1: enable
Now status:
WAN[1] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[2] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[3] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[4] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[5] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[6] Rip Protocol enable
WAN[7] Rip Protocol enable
> ip wanrip 5 -e 1
> ip wanrip ?
Valid ex:ip wanrip <ifno> -e <0/1>
<ifno> 1: WAN1,2: WAN2
3: PVC3,4: PVC4,5: PVC5
-e <0/1> 0: disable, 1: enable
Now status:
WAN[1] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[2] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[3] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[4] Rip Protocol disable
WAN[5] Rip Protocol enable
Syntax
ip route add [dst] [netmask][gateway][ifno][rtype]
ip route del [dst] [netmask][rtype]
ip route status
ip route cnc
ip route default [wan1/wan2/off/?]
ip route clean [1/0]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
add It means to add an IP address as static route.
del It means to delete specified IP address.
status It means current status of static route.
dst It means the IP address of the destination.
netmask It means the netmask of the specified IP address.
gateway It means the gateway of the connected router.
ifno It means the connection interface.
3=WAN1 5=WAN3,6=WAN4,7=WAN5
However,
WAN3, WAN4, WAN5 are router-borne WANs
rtype It means the type of the route.
default : default route;
static: static route.
cnc It means current IP range for CNC Network.
default Set WAN1/WAN2/off as current default route.
clean Clean all of the route settings.
1: Enable the function.
0: Disable the function.
Example
> ip route add 172.16.2.0 255.255.255.0 172.16.2.4 3 static
> ip route status
Syntax
ip igmp_proxy set
ip igmp_proxy reset
ip igmp_proxy wan
ip igmp_proxy t_home[on/off/show/help]
ip igmp_proxy query
ip igmp_proxy ppp [0/1]
ip igmp_proxy status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
set It means to enable proxy server.
reset It means to disable proxy server.
wan It means to specify WAN interface for IGMP service.
t_home It means to specify t_home proxy server for using.
On/off/show/help It means to turn on/off/display or get more information of the
T_home service.
query It means to set IGMP general query interval.
The default value is 125000 ms.
ppp 0 – No need to set IGMP with PPP header.
1 – Set IGMP with PPP header.
status It means to display current status for proxy server.
Example
> ip igmp t_home on
%T-Home Setting:
%T-Home Service is turned on.
%WAN1 : Enabled, connection type: PPPoE, without tag for ADSL
%WAN5 : Enabled, connection type: DHCP, tag: 8
%: PVC4(WAN5) is bound to PVC0(WAN1), protocol=MPoA 1483 Bridge
%IGMP Proxy Interface: WAN5(PVC)
%WAN5 for Router-borne Application/ IPTV on/off: ON
> ip igmp_proxy query 130000
This command is for setting IGMP General Query Interval
The default value is 125000 ms
Current Setting is:130000 ms
>
Syntax
ip dmz [mac]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
mac It means the MAC address of the device that you want to specify
Example
>ip dmz ?
% ip dmz <mac>, now : 00-00-00-00-00-00
> ip dmz 11-22-33-44-55-66
> ip dmz ?
% ip dmz <mac>, now : 11-22-33-44-55-66
>
Syntax
ip session on
ip session off
ip session default [num]
ip session defaultp2p [num]
ip session status
ip session show
ip session timer [num]
ip session [block/unblock][IP]
ip session [add/del][IP1-IP2][num][p2pnum]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on It means to turn on session limit for each IP.
off It means to turn off session limit for each IP.
default [num] It means to set the default number of session num limit.
Defautlp2p [num] It means to set the default number of session num limit for p2p.
status It means to display the current settings.
show It means to display all session limit settings in the IP range.
timer [num] It means to set when the IP session block works.
The unit is second.
Example
>ip session default 100
> ip session add 192.168.1.5-192.168.1.100 100 50
> ip session on
> ip session status
IP range:
192.168.1.5 - 192.168.1.100 : 100
Syntax
ip bandwidth on
ip bandwidth off
ip bandwidth default [tx_rate][rx_rate]
ip bandwidth status
ip bandwidth show
ip bandwidth [add/del] [IP1-IP2][tx][rx][shared]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on It means to turn on the IP bandwidth limit.
off It means to turn off the IP bandwidth limit.
default [tx_rate][rx_rate] It means to set default tx and rx rate of bandwidth limit. The
range is from 0 – 65535 Kpbs.
status It means to display the current settings.
show It means to display all the bandwidth limits settings within the IP
range.
add It means to add the bandwidth within the IP range.
del It means to delete the bandwidth within the IP range.
IP1-IP2 It means the range of IP address specified for this command.
Example
> ip bandwidth default 200 800
> ip bandwidth add 192.168.1.50-192.168.1.100 10 60
> ip bandwidth status
IP range:
192.168.1.50 - 192.168.1.100 : Tx:10K Rx:60K
Syntax
ip bindmac on
ip bindmac off
ip bindmac strict_on
ip bindmac show
ip bindmac add [IP][MAC][Comment]
ip bindmac del [IP]/all
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on It means to turn on IP bandmac policy. Even the IP is not in the
policy table, it can still access into network.
off It means to turn off all the bindmac policy.
strict_on It means that only those IP address in IP bindmac policy table can
access into network.
show It means to display the IP address and MAC address of the pair of
binded one.
add It means to add one ip bindmac.
del It means to delete one ip bindmac.
IP It means to type the IP address for binding with specified MAC
address.
MAC It means to type the MAC address for binding with the IP address
specified.
Comment It means to type words as a brief description.
All It means to delete all the IP bindmac settings.
Syntax
ip maxnatuser user no
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
User no A number specified here means the total NAT users that Vigor router
supports.
0 – It means no limitation.
Example
> ip maxnatuser 100
% Max NAT user = 100
Syntax
ip policy_rt [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
<command><parameter>|…] The available commands with parameters are listed below.
[…] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
General Setup for Policy Route
-i [value] Specify an index number for setting policy route profile.
Value: 1 to 60. “-1” means to get a free policy index automatically.
-e [0/1] 0: Disable the selected policy route profile.
1: Enable the selected policy route profile.
-o [value] Determine the operation of the policy route.
Value:
add – Create a new policy rotue profile.
del – Remove an existed policy route profile.
edit – Modify an existed policy route profile.
flush – Reset policy route to default setting.
-1 [any/range] Specify the source IP mode.
Range: Indicate a range of IP addresses.
Any: It means any IP address will be treated as source IP address.
-2 Specify the destination IP mode.
[any/ip_range/ip_subnet/do Any: No need to specify an IP address for any IP address will be
main] treated as destination IP address.
ip_range: Indicates a range of IP addresses.
ip_subnet: Indicates the IP subnet.
domain: Indicates the domain name.
-3 [any/range] Specify the destination port mode.
Range: Indicate a range of port number.
Example
> ip policy_rt diagnose -s 192.168.1.100 -d any -p any -t ICMP
-------------------------------------------------
Matched Route (Priority)
-------------------------------------------------
* No_Match
-------------------------------------------------
Matched Policy (Priority)
-------------------------------------------------
* Policy_1 (200)
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-a <IP Address> Set forwarded DNS server IP Address.
-d <DNS server mapping Delete the selected LAN DNS profile.
index number>
-e <0/1> 0: disable such function.
1: enable such function.
Example
> ip dnsforward -i 1 -n ftp.drayTek.com
% Configure Set1's DomainName:ftp.drayTek.com
> ip dnsforward -i 1 -a 172.16.1.1
% Configure Set1's IP:172.16.1.1
> ip dnsforward -i 1 -l
% Idx: 1
% State: Disable
% Profile: test
% Domain Name: ftp.drayTek.com
% DNS Server IP: 172.16.1.1
>
Syntax
ip6 addr -s [prefix] [prefix-length] [LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface#]
ip6 addr -d [prefix] [prefix-length] [LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface#]
ip6 addr -a [LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface#]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-s It means to add a static ipv6 address.
-d It means to delete an ipv6 address.
-a It means to show current address(es) status.
-u It means to show only unicast addresses.
prefix It means to type the prefix number of IPv6 address.
prefix-length It means to type a fixed value as the length of the prefix.
LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface# It means to specify LAN or WAN interface for such address.
Example
> ip6 addr -a
LAN
Unicast Address:
FE80::250:7FFF:FE00:0/64 (Link)
Multicast Address:
Syntax
ip6 dhcp req_opt [LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface#] [-<command> <parameter>| ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
req_opt It means option-request.
LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface# It means to specify LAN or WAN interface for such address.
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-a It means to show current DHCPv6 status.
-s It means to ask the SIP.
-S It means to ask the SIP name.
-d It means to ask the DNS setting.
-D It means to ask the DNS name.
-n It means to ask NTP.
-i It means to ask NIS.
-I It means to ask NIS name.
-p It means to ask NISP.
-P It means to ask NISP name.
-b It means to ask BCMCS.
-B It means to ask BCMCS name.
-r It means to ask refresh time.
Parameter 1: the parameter related to the request will be displayed.
0: the parameter related to the request will not be displayed.
Example
> ip6 dhcp req_opt WAN2 -S 1
> ip6 dhcp req_opt WAN2 -r 1
> ip6 dhcp req_opt WAN2 -a
% Interface WAN2 is set to request following DHCPv6 options:
% sip name
>
Syntax
ip6 dhcp client [WAN1|WAN2|iface#] [-<command> <parameter>| ... ]
Example
> ip6 dhcp client WAN2 –p 2008::1
> ip6 dhcp client WAN2 –a
Interface WAN2 has following DHCPv6 client settings:
DHCPv6 client enabled
request IA_PD whose IAID equals to 2008
> ip6 dhcp client WAN2 –n 1023456
> ip6 dhcp client WAN2 –a
Interface WAN2 has following DHCPv6 client settings:
DHCPv6 client enabled
request IA_NA whose IAID equals to 2008
> system reboot
Syntax
ip6 dhcp server [-<command> <parameter>| ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
server It means the dhcp server settings.
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-a It means to show current DHCPv6 status.
-i<pool_min_addr> It means to set the start IPv6 address of the address pool.
-x<pool_max_addr> It means to set the end IPv6 address of the address pool.
-d<addr> It means to set the first DNS IPv6 address.
-D<addr> It means to set the second DNS IPv6 address.
-c<parameter> It means to send rapid commit to server.
1: Enable
Example
> ip6 dhcp server -d FF02::1
> ip6 dhcp server -i ff02::1
> ip6 dhcp server -x ff02::3
> ip6 dhcp server -a
% Interface LAN has following DHCPv6 server settings:
% DHCPv6 server disabled
% maximum address of the pool: FF02::3
% minimum address of the pool: FF02::1
% 1st DNS IPv6 Addr: FF02::1
Syntax
ip6 internet -W n -M n [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-W n W means to set WAN interface and n means different selections.
Default is WAN1.
n=1: WAN1
n=2: WAN2
n=3: WAN3
.
.
n=X: WANx
-M n M means to set Internet Access Mode (Mandatory) and n means
different modes (represented by 0 – 5)
n= 0: Offline,
n=1: PPP,
n=2: TSPC,
n=3: AICCU,
n=4: DHCPv6,
n=5: Static
n=6:6in4-Static
n=7:6rd
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-m n It means to set IPv6 MTU.
N = any value (0 means “unspecified”).
-u <username> It means to set Username.
Example
> ip6 internet -W 2 -M 2 -u 88886666 -p draytek123456 –s
amsterdam.freenet6.net
This setting will take effect after rebooting.
Please use "sys reboot" command to reboot the router.
> system reboot
Syntax
ip6 neigh -s[ inet6_addr] [eth_addr] [LAN|WAN1|WAN2]
ip6 neigh -d [inet6_addr] [LAN|WAN1|WAN2]
ip6 neigh -a [inet6_addr] [-N LAN|WAN1|WAN2]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-s It means to add a neighbour.
-d It means to delete a neighbour.
-a It means to show neighbour status.
inet6_addr Type an IPv6 address
eth_addr Type submask address.
LAN|WAN1|WAN2 Specify an interface for the neighbor.
Example
> ip6 neigh -s 2001:2222:3333::1111 00:50:7F:11:ac:22:WAN2
Neighbour 2001:2222:3333::1111 successfully added!
> ip6 neigh -a
Syntax
ip6 pneigh -s inet6_addr [LAN|WAN1|WAN2]
ip6 pneigh -d inet6_addr [LAN|WAN1|WAN2]
ip6 pneigh -a [inet6_addr] [-N LAN|WAN1|WAN2]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-s It means to add a proxy neighbour.
-d It means to delete a proxy neighbour.
-a It means to show proxy neighbour status.
inet6_addr Type an IPv6 address
LAN|WAN1|WAN2 Specify an interface for the proxy neighbor.
Example
> ip6 neigh -s FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:300 LAN
% Neighbour FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:300 successfully added!
Syntax
ip6 route -s [prefix] [prefix-length] [gateway] [LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface#> [-D]
ip6 route -d [prefix] [prefix-length]
ip6 route -a [LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface#]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-s It means to add a route.
-d It means to delete a route.
-a It means to show the route status.
-D It means that such route will be treated as the default route.
prefix It means to type the prefix number of IPv6 address.
prefix-length It means to type a fixed value as the length of the prefix.
gateway It means the gateway of the router.
LAN|WAN1|WAN2|iface# It means to specify LAN or WAN interface for such address.
Example
> ip6 route -s FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:500 16 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:100 LAN
% Route FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:500/16 successfully added!
> ip6 route -a LAN
Syntax
ip6 ping [IPV6 address/Host] [LAN/WAN1/WAN2]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IPV6 address/Host It means to specify the IPv6 address or host for ping.
LAN/WAN1/WAN2 It means to specify LAN or WAN interface for such address.
Example
> ip6 ping 2001:4860:4860::8888 WAN2
Syntax
ip6 tracert [IPV6 address/Host]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IPV6 address/Host It means to specify the IPv6 address or host for ping.
Example
> ip6 tracert 2001:4860:4860::8888
traceroute to 2001:4860:4860::8888, 30 hops max through protocol ICMP
1 2001:5C0:1400:B::10B8 340 ms
2 2001:4DE0:1000:A22::1 330 ms
3 2001:4DE0:A::1 330 ms
4 2001:4DE0:1000:34::1 340 ms
5 2001:7F8:1: :A501:5169:1 330 ms
6 2001:4860::1:0:4B3 350 ms
7 2001:4860::8:0:2DAF 330 ms
8 2001:4860::2:0:66E 340 ms
9 Request timed out. *
10 2001:4860:4860::8888 350 ms
Trace complete.
>
Syntax
ip6 tspc [ifno]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ifno It means the connection interface.
Ifno=1 (means WAN1)
Info=2 (means WAN2)
Example
> ip6 tspc 2
Local Endpoint v4 Address : 111.243.177.223
Local Endpoint v6 Address : 2001:05c0:1400:000b:0000:0000:0000:10b9
Router DNS name : 8886666.broker.freenet6.net
Remote Endpoint v4 Address :81.171.72.11
Remote Endpoint v6 Address : 2001:05c0:1400:000b:0000:0000:0000:10b8
Tspc Prefixlen : 56
Tunnel Broker: Amsterdam.freenet.net
>
Syntax
Ip6 radvd –s [1|0] [lifetime]
ip6 radvd –V
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-s It means to enable or disable the default lifetime of the RADVD
server.
1: Enable the RADVD server.
0: Disable the RADVD server.
Lifetime It means to set the lifetime.
The lifetime associated with the default router in units of seconds.
It’s used to control the lifetime of the prefix. The maximum value
corresponds to 18.2 hours. A lifetime of 0 indicates that the router
is not a default router and should not appear on the default router
list.
Type the number (unit: second) you want.
-V It means to show the RADVD configuration.
-r It means RA default test.
-r [num] It means RA test for item [num].
Example
> ip6 radvd -s 1 1800
> ip6 radvd -V
% IPv6 Radvd Config:
Radvd : Enable, Default Lifetime : 1800 seconds
Syntax
ip6 mngt list
ip6 mngt list [add<index> <prefix> <prefix-length>|remove <index>|flush]
ip6 mngt status
ip6 mngt [http|telnet|ping|https|ssh] [on|off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
list It means to show the setting information of the access list.
status It means to show the status of IPv6 management.
add It means to add an IPv6 address which can be used to execute
Example
> ip6 mngt list add 1 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:1010 128
> ip6 mngt list add 2 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:1020 128
> ip6 mngt list add 3 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:2080 128
> ip6 mngt list
% IPv6 Access List :
Index IPv6 Prefix Prefix Length
========================================
1 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:1010 128
2 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:1020 128
3 FE80::250:7FFF:FE12:2080 128
Syntax
ip6 online [ifno]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ifno It means the connection interface.
0=LAN1
1=WAN1
2=WAN2
Example
> ip6 online 0
% LAN 1 online status :
% Interface : UP
% IPv6 DNS Server: :: Static
% IPv6 DNS Server: :: Static
% IPv6 DNS Server: :: Static
Syntax
ip6 aiccu [ifno]
ip6 aiccu subnet [add <ifno> <prefix> <prefix-length>|remove <ifno>|show <info>]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ifno It means the connection interface.
1=WAN1
2=WAN2
add It means to add an IPv6 address which can be used to execute
management through Internet.
prefix It means to type the IPv6 address which will be used for accessing
Internet.
prefix-length It means to type a fixed value as the length of the prefix.
remove It means to remove (delete) the specified index number with IPv6
settings.
show It means to display the AICCU status.
Example
> ip6 aiccu subnet add 2 2001:1111:0000::1111 64
> ip6 aiccu 2
Status: Connecting
Syntax
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
–h It is used to display the usage of such command.
-v It is used to show the NTP state.
-p <0/1> It is used to specify NTP server for IPv6.
0 – Auto
1 – First Query IPv6 NTP Server.
Example
> ip6 ntp -p 1
% Set NTP Priority: IPv6 First
Syntax
ipf view [-VcdhrtzZ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-V It means to show the version of this IP filter.
-c It means to show the running call filter rules.
-d It means to show the running data filter rules.
-h It means to show the hit-number of the filter rules.
-r It means to show the running call and data filter rules.
-t It means to display all the information at one time.
-z It means to clear a filter rule’s statistics.
-Z It means to clear IP filter’s gross statistics.
Example
> ipf view -V -c -d
ipf: IP Filter: v3.3.1 (1824)
Kernel: IP Filter: v3.3.1
Running: yes
Log Flags: 0x80947278 = nonip
Default: pass all, Logging: available
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Options There are several options provided here, such as -v, -c [SET_NO], -d
[SET_NO],… and etc.
SET_NO It means to specify the index number (from 1 to 12) of filter set.
RULE_NO It means to specify the index number (from 1 to 7) of filter rule set.
-v Type “-v” to view the configuration of general set.
-c [SET_NO] It means to setup Call Filter, e.g., -c 2. The range for the index
number you can type is “0” to “12” (0 means “disable).
-d [SET_NO] It means to setup Data Filter, e.g., -d 3. The range for the index
number you can type is “0” to “12” (0 means “disable).
-l [VALUE] It means to setup Log Flag, e.g., -l 2
Type “0” to disable the log flag.
Type “1” to display the log of passed packet.
Type “2” to display the log of blocked packet.
Type “3” to display the log of non-matching packet.
- p [VALUE] It means to setup actions for packet not matching any rule, e.g., -p
1
Type “0” to let all the packets pass;
Type “1” to block all the packets.
-M [P2P_NO] It means to configure IM/P2P for the packets not matching with any
rule, e.g., -M 1
Type “0” to let all the packets pass;
Type “1” to block all the packets.
-U [URL_NO] It means to configure URL content filter for the packets not
matching with any rule, e.g., -U 1
Type “0” to let all the packets pass;
Type “1” to block all the packets.
-a [AD_SET] It means to configure the advanced settings.
-f [VALUE] It means to accept large incoming fragmented UDP or ICMP packets.
-E [VALUE] It means to set the maximum count for session limitation.
-F [VALUE] It means to configure the load-balance policy.
-Q [VALUE] It means to set the QoS class.
Example
> ipf set -c 1 #set call filter start from set 1
Setting saved.
Syntax
ipf rule s r [-<command> <parameter> | ...
ipf rule s r -v
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
s Such word means Filter Set, range form 1~12.
r Such word means Filter Rule, range from 1~7.
<Command><parameter> The following lists all of the available commands with parameters.
-e It means to enable or disable the rule setting.
0- disable
1- enable
-s o:g <obj> It means to specify source IP object and IP group.
o - indicates “object”.
g - indicates “group”.
obj - indicates index number of object or index number of group.
Available settings range from 1-192. For example, “-s g 3" means
the third source IP group profile.
–s u <Address Type> <Start IP It means to configure source IP address including address type,
Address> <End IP Address> | start IP address, end IP address and address mask.
<Address Mask> u – It means “user defined”.
Address Type - Type the number (representing different address
Example
> ipf rule 2 1 -e 1 -s "o 1" -d "o 2" -S "o 1" -F 2
> ipf rule 2 1 -v
------------------------------------------------------------------
---
Strict Security Checking
[ ]APP Enforcement
Syntax
ipf flowtrack set [-re]
ipf flowtrack view [-f]
ipf flowtrack [-i][-p][-t]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-r It means to refresh the flowtrack.
-e It means to enable or disable the flowtrack.
0: Disable
1: Enable
-f It means to show the sessions state of flowtrack. If you do not
Example
>ipf flowtrack set -r
Refresh the flowstate ok
> ipf flowtrack view -f
Start to show the flowtrack sessions state:
Syntax
log [-cfhiptwx?] [-F a| c | f | w]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-c It means to show the latest call log.
-f It means to show the IP filter log.
-F It means to show the flush log buffer.
a: flush all logs
c: flush the call log
f: flush the IP filter log
w: flush the WAN log
-h It means to show this usage help.
-p It means to show PPP/MP log.
Example
> log -w
25:36:25.580 ---->DHCP (WAN-5) Len = 548XID = 0x7880fdd4
Client IP = 0.0.0.0
Your IP = 0.0.0.0
Next server IP = 0.0.0.0
Relay agent IP = 0.0.0.0
25:36:33.580 ---->DHCP (WAN-5) Len = 548XID = 0x7880fdd4
Client IP = 0.0.0.0
Your IP = 0.0.0.0
Next server IP = 0.0.0.0
Relay agent IP = 0.0.0.0
25:36:41.580 ---->DHCP (WAN-5) Len = 548XID = 0x7880fdd4
Client IP = 0.0.0.0
Your IP = 0.0.0.0
Next server IP = 0.0.0.0
Relay agent IP = 0.0.0.0
25:36:49.580 ---->DHCP (WAN-5) Len = 548XID = 0x7880fdd4
Client IP = 0.0.0.0
Your IP = 0.0.0.0
Next server IP = 0.0.0.0
Relay agent IP = 0.0.0.0
25:36:57.580 ---->DHCP (WAN-5) Len = 548XID = 0x7880fdd4
Client IP = 0.0.0.0
Your IP = 0.0.0.0
--- MORE --- ['q': Quit, 'Enter': New Lines, 'Space Bar': Next Page]
---
Syntax
mngt ftpport [FTP port]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
FTP port It means to type the number for FTP port. The default setting is
21.
Example
> mngt ftpport 21
% Set FTP server port to 21 done.
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Http port It means to enter the number for HTTP port. The default setting is
80.
Example
> mngt httpport 80
% Set web server port to 80 done.
Syntax
mngt httpsport [Https port]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Https port It means to type the number for HTTPS port. The default setting is
443.
Example
> mngt httpsport 443
% Set web server port to 443 done.
Syntax
mngt telnetport [Telnet port]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Telnet port It means to type the number for telnet port. The default setting is
23.
Example
> mngt telnetport 23
% Set Telnet server port to 23 done.
Syntax
mngt sshport [ssh port]
Example
> mngt sshport 23
% Set ssh port to 23 done.
Syntax
mngt ftpserver [enable]
mngt ftpserver [disable]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable It means to activate FTP server function.
disable It means to inactivate FTP server function.
Example
> mngt ftpserver enable
%% FTP server has been enabled.
Syntax
mngt noping [on]
mngt noping [off]
mngt noping [viewlog]
mngt noping [clearlog]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on All PING packets will be forwarded from LAN PC to Internet.
off All PING packets will be blocked from LAN PC to Internet.
viewlog It means to display a log of ping action, including source MAC and
source IP.
clearlog It means to clear the log of ping action.
Example
Syntax
mngt defenseworm [on]
mngt defenseworm [off]
mngt defenseworm [add port]
mngt defenseworm [del port]
mngt defenseworm [viewlog]
mngt defenseworm [clearlog]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on It means to activate the function of defense worm packet out.
off It means to inactivate the function of defense worm packet out.
add port It means to add a new TCP port for block.
del port It means to delete a TCP port for block.
viewlog It means to display a log of defense worm packet, including source
MAC and source IP.
clearlog It means to remove the log of defense worm packet.
Example
> mngt defenseworm add 21
Add TCP port 21
Block TCP port list: 135, 137, 138, 139, 445, 21
> mngt defenseworm del 21
Delete TCP port 21
Block TCP port list: 135, 137, 138, 139, 445
Syntax
mngt rmtcfg [status]
mngt rmtcfg [enable]
mngt rmtcfg [disable]
mngt rmtcfg [http/https/ftp/telnet/ssh/tr069] [on/off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Example
> mngt rmtcfg ftp on
Enable server fail
Remote configure function has been disabled
please enable by enter mngt rmtcfg enable
Syntax
mngt lanaccess -e [0/1] –s [value] –i [value]
mngt lanaccess –f
mngt lanaccess –d
mngt lanaccess –v
mngt lanaccess –h
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-e[0/1] It means to enable/disable the function.
0-disable the function.
1-enable the function.
-s[value] It means to specify service offered.
Available values include:
FTP, HTTP, HTTPS, TELNET, SSH, None, All
-i[value] It means the interface which is allowed to access.
Available values include:
LAN2~LAN6, DMZ, IP Routed Subnet, None, All
Note: LAN1 is always allowed for accessing into the router.
-f It means to flush all of the settings.
-d It means to restore the factory default settings.
-v It means to view current settings.
-h It means to get the usage of such command.
Note: the settings do NOT apply to LAN1, LAN1 is always allowed to access
the router
Syntax
mngt echoicmp [enable]
mngt echoicmp [disable]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable It means to accept the echo ICMP packet.
disable It means to drop the echo ICMP packet.
Example
> mngt echoicmp enable
%% Echo ICMP packet enabled.
Syntax
mngt accesslist list
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
list It can display current setting for your reference.
add It means adding a new entry.
index It means to specify the number of the entry.
ip addr It means to specify an IP address.
mask It means to specify the subnet mask for the IP address.
remove It means to delete the selected item.
flush It means to remove all the settings in the access list.
Example
> mngt accesslist add 1 192.168.1.89 255.255.255.0
%% Set OK.
> mngt accesslist list
%% Access list :
Index IP address Subnet mask
==========================================
1 192.168.1.89 255.255.255.0
Syntax
mngt snmp [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-e <1/2> 1: Enable the SNMP function.
2: Disable the SNMP function.
-g<Community name> It means to set the name for getting community by typing a proper
character. (max. 23 characters)
-s <Community name> It means to set community by typing a proper name. (max. 23
characters)
-m <IP address> It means to set one host as the manager to execute SNMP function.
Please type in IPv4 address to specify certain host.
-t <Community name> It means to set trap community by typing a proper name. (max. 23
characters)
-n <IP address> It means to set the IPv4 address of the host that will receive the
trap community.
-T <seconds> It means to set the trap timeout <0~999>.
Example
> mngt snmp -e 1 -g draytek -s DK -m 192.168.1.1 -t trapcom -n 10.20.3.40
-T 88
SNMP Agent Turn on!!!
Get Community set to draytek
Set Community set to DK
Manager Host IP set to 192.168.1.1
Trap Community set to trapcom
Notification Host IP set to 10.20.3.40
Trap Timeout set to 88 seconds
Syntax
msubnet switch [2/3/4/5/6][On/Off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
6=LAN6
On/Off On means turning on the subnet for the specified LAN interface.
Off means turning off the subnet.
Example
> msubnet switch 2 On
% LAN2 Subnet On!
Syntax
msubnet addr [2/3/4/5/6][IP address]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
Example
> msubnet addr 2 192.168.5.1
% Set LAN2 subnet IP address done !!!
Syntax
msubnet nmask [2/3/4/5/6][IP address]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
6=LAN6
IP address Type the subnet mask address for the specified LAN interface.
Example
> msubnet nmask 2 255.255.0.0
% Set LAN2 subnet mask done !!!
Syntax
msubnet status [2/3/4/5/6]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
Example
> msubnet status 2
% LAN2 Off: 0.0.0.0/0.0.0.0, PPP Start IP: 0.0.0.60
% DHCP server: Off
% Dhcp Gateway: 0.0.0.0, Start IP: 0.0.0.10, Pool Count: 50
Syntax
msubnet dhcps [2/3/4/5/6][On/Off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
6=LAN6
On/Off On means enabling the DHCP server for the specified LAN interface.
Off means disabling the DHCP server.
Example
> msubnet dhcps 3 off
% LAN3 Subnet DHCP Server disabled!
Syntax
msubnet nat [2/3/4/5/6] [On/Off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
6=LAN6
On/Off On – It means the subnet will be configured for NAT usage.
Example
> > msubnet nat 2 off
% LAN2 Subnet is for Routing usage!
%Note: If you have multiple WAN connections, please be reminded to setup
a Load-Balance policy so that packets from this subnet will be forwarded
to the right WAN interface!
Syntax
msubnet gateway [2/3/4] [Gateway IP]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
6=LAN6
Gateway IP Specify an IP address as the gateway IP.
Example
> msubnet gateway 2 192.168.1.13
% Set LAN2 Dhcp Gateway IP done !!!
Syntax
msubnet ipcnt [2/3/4] [IP counts]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
Example
> msubnet ipcnt 2 15
This setting will take effect after rebooting.
Please use "sys reboot" command to reboot the router.
Syntax
msubnet talk [1/2/3/4/5/6] [1/2/3/4/5/6] [On/Off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
1/2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
1=LAN1
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
6=LAN6
On/Off On – It means
Off - It means
Example
> msubnet talk 1 2 on
% Enable routing between LAN1 and LAN2 !
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
6=LAN6
Gateway IP Type an IP address as the starting IP address for a subnet.
Example
> msubnet startip 2 192.168.2.90
%Set LAN2 Dhcp Start IP done !!!
Syntax
msubnet pppip [2/3/4/5/6] [Start IP]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
6=LAN6
Start IP Type an IP address as the starting IP address for PPP connection.
Example
> msubnet pppip 2 192.168.2.250
% Set LAN2 PPP(IPCP) Start IP done !!!
Syntax
msubnet nodetype [2/3/4/5/6][count]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
6=LAN6
count Choose the following number for specifying different node type.
1= B-node
2= P-node
4= M-node
8= H-node
0= Not specify any type for node.
Example
> msubnet nodetype ?
% msubnet nodetype <2/3/4/5/6> <count>
% Now: LAN2 0; LAN3 0; LAN4 0; LAN5 0; LAN6 0
Syntax
msubnet primWINS [2/3/4/5/6] [WINS IP]
Syntax Description
Example
> > msubnet primWINS ?
% msubnet primWINS <2/3/4/5/6> <WINS IP>
% Now: LAN2 0.0.0.0; LAN3 0.0.0.0; LAN4 0.0.0.0; LAN5 0.0.0.0; LAN6
0.0.0.0
Syntax
msubnet secWINS [2/3/4/5/6] [WINS IP]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
6=LAN6
WINS IP Type the IP address as the WINS IP.
Example
> > msubnet secWINS 2 192.168.3.89
% Set LAN2 Dhcp Secondary WINS IP done !!!
Syntax
msubnet tftp [2/3/4/5/6] [TFTP server name]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
2/3/4/5/6 It means LAN interface.
2=LAN2
3=LAN3
4=LAN4
5=LAN5
6=LAN6
TFTP server name Type a name to indicate the TFTP server.
Example
> msubnet tftp ?
% msubnet tftp <2/3/4/5/6> <TFTP server name>
% Now: LAN2
LAN3
LAN4
LAN5
LAN6
Syntax
msubnet mtu [interface][value]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
interface Available settings include LAN1~LAN6, IP_Routed_Subnet, and DMZ.
value 1000 ~ 1508 (Bytes), default: 1500 (Bytes)
Example
<interface>: LAN1~LAN6,IP_Routed_Subnet,DMZ
<value>: 1000 ~ 1508 (Bytes), default: 1500 (Bytes)
Current Settings:
Syntax
object ip obj setdefault
object ip obj INDEX -v
object ip obj INDEX -n NAME
object ip obj INDEX -i INTERFACE
object ip obj INDEX -s INVERT
object ip obj INDEX -a TYPE [START_IP] [END/MASK_IP]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number of the specified object profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified object profile.
Example: object ip obj 1 -v
-n NAME It means to define a name for the IP object.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
Example: object ip obj 9 -n bruce
-i INTERFACE It means to define an interface for the IP object.
INTERFACE=0, means any
INTERFACE=1, means LAN
INTERFACE=3, means WAN
Example: object ip obj 8 -i 0
Example
> object ip obj 1 -n marketing
> object ip obj 1 -a 1 192.168.1.45
> object ip obj 1 -v
IP Object Profile 1
Name :[marketing]
Interface:[Any]
Address type:[single]
Start ip address:[192.168.1.45]
End/Mask ip address:[0.0.0.0]
Invert Selection:[0]
Syntax
object ip grp setdefault
object ip grp INDEX -v
object ip grp INDEX -n NAME
object ip grp INDEX -i INTERFACE
object ip grp INDEX -a IP_OBJ_INDEX
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number of the specified group profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified group profile.
Example: object ip grp 1 -v
-n NAME It means to define a name for the IP group.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
Example: object ip grp 8 -n bruce
-i INTERFACE It means to define an interface for the IP group.
Example
> object ip grp 2 -n First
IP Group Profile 2
Name :[First]
Interface:[Any]
Included ip object index:
[0:][0]
[1:][0]
[2:][0]
[3:][0]
[4:][0]
[5:][0]
[6:][0]
[7:][0]
Syntax
object ip obj setdefault
object ip obj INDEX -v
object ip obj INDEX -n NAME
object ip obj INDEX -i INTERFACE
object ip obj INDEX -s INVERT
object ip obj INDEX -a TYPE [START_IP] [END/MASK_IP]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number of the specified object profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified object profile.
Example: object ip obj 1 -v
-n NAME It means to define a name for the IP object.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
Example: object ip obj 9 -n bruce
-i INTERFACE It means to define an interface for the IP object.
INTERFACE=0, means any
INTERFACE=1, means LAN
INTERFACE=3, means WAN
Example: object ip obj 8 -i 0
-s INVERT It means to set invert seletion for the object profile.
INVERT=0, means disableing the function.
INVERT=1, means enabling the function.
Example: object ip obj 3 -s 1
-a TYPE It means to set the address type and IP for the IP object profile.
TYPE=0, means Mask
TYPE=1, means Single
TYPE=2, means Any
TYPE=3, means Rang
Example: object ip obj 3 -a 2
[START_IP] When the TYPE is set with 2, you have to type an IP address as a
starting point and another IP address as end point.
Type an IP address.
[END/MASK_IP] Type an IP address (different with START_IP) as the end IP address.
Example
> object ip obj 1 -n marketing
> object ip obj 1 -a 1 192.168.1.45
> object ip obj 1 -v
IP Object Profile 1
Name :[marketing]
Syntax
object ip grp setdefault
object ip grp INDEX -v
object ip grp INDEX -n NAME
object ip grp INDEX -i INTERFACE
object ip grp INDEX -a IP_OBJ_INDEX
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number of the specified group profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified group profile.
Example: object ip grp 1 -v
-n NAME It means to define a name for the IP group.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
Example: object ip grp 8 -n bruce
-i INTERFACE It means to define an interface for the IP group.
INTERFACE=0, means any
INTERFACE=1, means LAN
INTERFACE=2, means WAN
Example: object ip grp 3 -i 0
-a IP_OBJ_INDEX It means to specify IP object profiles for the group profile.
Example: :object ip grp 3 -a 1 2 3 4 5
The IP object profiles with index number 1,2,3,4 and 5 will be group
under such profile.
Example
> object ip grp 2 -n First
IP Group Profile 2
Name :[First]
Interface:[Any]
Included ip object index:
[0:][0]
[1:][0]
[2:][0]
[3:][0]
[4:][0]
[5:][0]
[6:][0]
Syntax
object service obj setdefault
object service obj INDEX -v
object service obj INDEX -n NAME
object service obj INDEX -p PROTOCOL
object service obj INDEX -s CHK [START_P] [END_P]
object service obj INDEX -d CHK [START_P] [END_P]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number of the specified service object profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified service object
profile.
Example: object service obj 1 -v
-n NAME It means to define a name for the IP object.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
Example: object service obj 9 -n bruce
-i PROTOCOL It means to define a PROTOCOL for the service object profile.
PROTOCOL =0, means any
PROTOCOL =1, means ICMP
PROTOCOL =2, means IGMP
PROTOCOL =6, means TCP
PROTOCOL =17, means UDP
PROTOCOL =255, means TCP/UDP
Other values mean other protocols.
Example: object service obj 8 -i 0
CHK It means the check action for the port setting.
0=equal(=), when the starting port and ending port values are the
Example
> object service obj 1 -n limit
> object service obj 1 -p 255
> object service obj 1 -s 1 120 240
> object service obj 1 -d 1 200 220
> object service obj 1 -v
Service Object Profile 1
Name :[limit]
Protocol:[255]
Source port check action:[!=]
Source port range:[120~240]
Destination port check action:[!=]
Destination port range:[200~220]
Syntax
object service grp setdefault
object service grp INDEX -v
object service grp INDEX -n NAME
object service grp INDEX -a SER_OBJ_INDEX
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number of the specified group profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified group profile.
Example: object service grp 1 -v
-n NAME It means to define a name for the service group.
Example
>object service grp 1 -n Grope_1
Service Group Profile 1
Name :[Grope_1]
Included service object index:
[0:][0]
[1:][0]
[2:][0]
[3:][0]
[4:][0]
[5:][0]
[6:][0]
[7:][0]
Syntax
object kw obj setdefault
object kw obj show PAGE
object kw obj INDEX -v
object kw obj INDEX -n NAME
object kw obj INDEX -a CONTENTS
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
show PAGE It means to show the contents of the specified profile.
Example
> object kw obj 1 -n children
Profile 1
Name :[children]
Content:[]
> object kw obj 1 -a gambling
Profile 1
Name :[children]
Content:[gambling]
Syntax
object fe show
object fe setdefault
object fe obj INDEX -v
object fe obj INDEX -n NAME
object fe obj INDEX -e CATEGORY|FILE_EXTENSION
object fe obj INDEX -d CATEGORY|FILE_EXTENSION
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show It means to show the contents for all of the profiles.
setdefault It means to return to default settings for all profiles.
INDEX It means the index number (from 1 to 8) of the specified file
extension object profile.
-v It means to view the information of the specified file extension
object profile.
-n NAME It means to define a name for the file extension object profile.
NAME: Type a name with less than 15 characters.
-e It means to enable the specific CATEGORY or FILE_EXTENSION.
Example
> object fe obj 1 -n music
> object fe obj 1 -e Audio
> object fe obj 1 -v
Profile Index: 1
Profile Name:[music]
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
------
Image category:
[ ].bmp [ ].dib [ ].gif [ ].jpeg [ ].jpg [ ].jpg2 [ ].jp2 [ ].pct
[ ].pcx [ ].pic [ ].pict [ ].png [ ].tif [ ].tiff
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
------
Video category:
[ ].asf [ ].avi [ ].mov [ ].mpe [ ].mpeg [ ].mpg [v].mp4 [ ].qt
[ ].rm [v].wmv [ ].3gp [ ].3gpp [ ].3gpp2 [ ].3g2
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
------
Audio category:
[v].aac [v].aiff [v].au [v].mp3 [v].m4a [v].m4p [v].ogg [v].ra
[v].ram [v].vox [v].wav [v].wma
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
------
Java category:
[ ].class [ ].jad [ ].jar [ ].jav [ ].java [ ].jcm [ ].js [ ].jse
[ ].jsp [ ].jtk
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
------
ActiveX category:
[ ].alx [ ].apb [ ].axs [ ].ocx [ ].olb [ ].ole [ ].tlb [ ].viv
[ ].vrm
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
------
Compression category:
[ ].ace [ ].arj [ ].bzip2 [ ].bz2 [ ].cab [ ].gz [ ].gzip [ ].rar
[ ].sit [ ].zip
Syntax
port [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, wan2, all] [AN, 100F, 100H, 10F, 10H, status]
port status
port sniff [on,off,port,txrx,restart,status]
port 802.1x[enable,disable,status,addport,delport]
port jumbo
port wanfc
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, wan2, all It means the number of LAN port and WAN port.
AN… 10H It means the physical type for the specific port.
AN: auto-negotiate.
100F: 100M Full Duplex.
100H: 100M Half Duplex.
10F: 10M Full Duplex.
10H: 10M Half Duplex.
status It means to view the Ethernet port status.
sniff
[on,off,port,txrx,restart,sta
tus]
802.1x[enable,disable,statu
s,addport,delport]
wanfc It means to set WAN flow control.
Example
> port 1 100F
%Set Port 1 Force speed 100 Full duplex OK !!!
Syntax
portmaptime [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Example
> portmaptime -t 86400 -u 300 -i 10
> portmaptime -l
------ Current setting ------
TCP Timeout : 86400 sec.
UDP Timeout : 300 sec.
IGMP Timeout : 10 sec.
TCP WWW Timeout: 60 sec.
TCP SYN Timeout: 60 sec.
Syntax
prn status
prn debug
Example
> prn status
Interface: USB bus 2.0
Printer: NotReady
Syntax
qos setup [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-h Type it to display the usage of this command.
-m <mode> It means to define which traffic the QoS control settings will apply
to and eable QoS control.
0: disable.
1: in, apply to incoming traffic only.
2: out, apply to outgoing traffic only.
3: both, apply to both incoming and outgoing traffic.
Default is enable (for outgoing traffic).
-i <bandwidth> It means to set inbound bandwidth in kbps (Ethernet WAN only)
The available setting is from 1 to 100000.
-o <bandwidth> It means to set outbound bandwidth in kbps (Ethernet WAN only).
The available setting is from 1 to 100000.
-r <index:ratio> It means to set ratio for class index, in %.
-u <mode> It means to enable bandwidth control for UDP.
0: disable
1: enable
Default is disable.
-p <ratio> It means to enable bandwidth limit ratio for UDP.
-t <mode> It means to enable/disable Outbound TCP ACK Prioritize.
0: disable
1: enable
-V Show all the settings.
-D Set all to factory default (for all WANs).
[…] It means that you can type in several commands in one line.
Example
> qos setup -m 3 -i 9500 -o 8500 -r 3:20 -u 1 -p 50 -t 1
Syntax
qos class -c [no] –[a|e|d] [no][-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-h Type it to display the usage of this command.
-c <no> Specify the inde number for the class.
Available value for <no> contains 1, 2 and 3. The default setting is
class 1.
-n <name> It means to type a name for the class.
-a It means to add rule for specified class.
-e <no> It means to edit specified rule.
<no>: type the index number for the rule.
-d <no> It means to delete specified rule.
<no>: type the index number for the rule.
-m <mode> It means to enable or disable the specified rule.
0: disable,
1: enable
-l <addr> Set the local address.
Addr1 – It means Single address. Please specify the IP address
directly, for example, “-l 172.16.3.9”.
addr1:addr2 – It means Range address. Please specify the IP
addresses, for example, “-l 172.16.3.9: 172.16.3.50.”
addr1:subnet – It means the subnet address with start IP address.
Please type the subnet and the IP address, for example, “-l
172.16.3.9:255.255.0.0”.0
any – It means Any address. Simple type “-l” to specify any address
for this command.
-r <addr> Set the remote address.
addr1 – It means Single address. Please specify the IP address
directly, for example, “-l 172.16.3.9”.
addr1:addr2 – It means Range address. Please specify the IP
addresses, for example, “-l 172.16.3.9: 172.16.3.50.”
addr1:subnet – It means the subnet address with start IP address.
Please type the subnet and the IP address, for example, “-l
172.16.3.9:255.255.0.0”.0
any – It means Any address. Simple type “-l” to specify any address
for this command.
-p <DSCP id> Specify the ID.
-s <Service type> Specify the service type by typing the number. The available types
are listed as below:
Example
> qos class -c 2 -n draytek -a -m 1 -l 192.168.1.50:192.168.1.80
Syntax
qos type [-a <service name> | -e <no> | -d <no>].
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-a <name> It means to add rule.
-e <no> It means to edit user defined service type. “no” means the index
number. Available numbers are 1~40.
-d <no> It means to delete user defined service type. “no” means the index
number. Available numbers are 1~40.
-n <name> It means the name of the service.
-t <type> It means protocol type.
6: tcp(default)
17: udp
0: tcp/udp
<1~254>: other
-p <port> It means service port. The typing format must be [start:end] (ex.,
510:330).
-l List user defined types. “no” means the index number. Available
numbers are 1~40.
Example
> show lan
The LAN settings:
ip mask dhcp star_ip pool gateway
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
-----
[V]LAN1 192.168.1.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 192.168.1.10 200
192.168.1.1
[X]LAN2 192.168.2.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 192.168.2.10 100
192.168.2.1
[X]LAN3 192.168.3.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 192.168.3.10 100
192.168.3.1
[X]LAN4 192.168.4.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 192.168.4.10 100
192.168.4.1
[X]LAN5 192.168.5.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 192.168.5.10 100
192.168.5.1
[X]LAN6 192.168.6.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 192.168.6.10 100
192.168.6.1
[X]Route 192.168.0.1 255.255.255.0 [V] 0.0.0.0 0 192.168.0.1
Example
> show dmz
% WAN1 DMZ mapping status:
Index Status WAN1 aux IP Private IP
----------------------------------------------------
1 Disable 172.16.3.221
2 Disable 192.168.1.65
Example
> show dns
%% Domain name server settings:
% Primary DNS: [Not set]
% Secondary DNS: [Not set]
Example
> show openport
%% Openport settings:
Index Status Comment Local IP Address
********************************************************
No data entry.
Example
> show nat
Port Redirection Running Table:
Example
> show portmap
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
Private_IP:Port Pseudo_IP:Port Peer_IP:Port [Timeout/Protocol/Flag]
-------------------------------------------------------------------------
-
Example
> show pmtime
Level0 TCP=86400001 UDP=300001 ICMP=10001
Level1 TCP=600000 UDP=90000 ICMP=7000
Level2 TCP=60000 UDP=30000 ICMP=5000
Example
> show session
% Maximum Session Number: 10000
% Maximum Session Usage: 49
% Current Session Usage: 0
% Current Session Used(include waiting for free): 0
% WAN1 Current Session Usage: 0
Example
> show status
System Uptime:20:36:35
LAN Status
Primary DNS:8.8.8.8 Secondary DNS:8.8.4.4
IP Address:192.168.1.1 Tx Rate:12923 Rx Rate:8152
Example
> Vigor> show adsl
--------------------------- ATU-R Info (hw: annex A, f/w: annex A) -----------
Running Mode : T1.413 State : TRAINING
DS Actual Rate : 0 bps US Actual Rate : 0 bps
DS Attainable Rate : 0 bps US Attainable Rate : 0 bps
DS Path Mode : Fast US Path Mode : Fast
DS Interleave Depth : 0 US Interleave Depth : 0
NE Current Attenuation : 0 dB Cur SNR Margin : 0 dB
DS actual PSD : 0. 0 dB US actual PSD : 0. 0 dB
ADSL Firmware Version : 05-04-04-04-00-01
-------------------------------- ATU-C Info ---------------------------------
Far Current Attenuation : 0 dB Far SNR Margin : 0 dB
CO ITU Version[0] : 00000000 CO ITU Version[1] : 00000000
DSLAM CHIPSET VENDOR : < ADI >
Syntax
show statistic
show statistic reset [interface]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
reset It means to reset the transmitted/received bytes to Zero.
interface It means to specify WAN1 ~WAN5 (including multi-PVC) interface for
displaying related statistics.
Example
> show statistic
WAN1 total TX: 0 Bytes ,RX: 0 Bytes
WAN2 total TX: 0 Bytes ,RX: 0 Bytes
WAN3 total TX: 0 Bytes ,RX: 0 Bytes
WAN4 total TX: 0 Bytes ,RX: 0 Bytes
WAN5 total TX: 0 Bytes ,RX: 0 Bytes
>
Syntax
srv dhcp badip
Example
> srv dhcp badip
>
Syntax
srv dhcp public start [IP address]
srv dhcp public cnt [IP counts]
srv dhcp public status
srv dhcp public add [MAC Addr XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX]
srv dhcp public del [MAC Addr XX-XX-XX-XX-XX-XX/all/ALL]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
start It means the starting point of the IP address pool for the DHCP
server.
IP address It means to specify an IP address as the starting point in the IP
address pool.
cnt It means the IP count number.
IP counts It means to specify the number of IP addresses in the pool. The
maximum is 10.
status It means the execution result of this command.
add It means creating a list of hosts to be assigned.
del It means removing the selected MAC address.
MAC Addr It means to specify MAC Address of the host.
all/ALL It means all of the MAC addresses.
Example
Vigor> ip route add 192.168.1.56 255.255.255.0 192.168.1.12 3 default
Vigor> srv dhcp public status
Index MAC Address
Syntax
srv dhcp dns1 [?]
srv dhcp dns1 [DNS IP address]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display current IP address of DNS 1 for the DHCP server.
DNS IP address It means the IP address that you want to use as DNS1.
Note: The IP Routed Subnet DNS must be the same as NAT Subnet
DNS).
Example
> srv dhcp dns1 168.95.1.1
% srv dhcp dns1 <DNS IP address>
% Now: 168.95.1.1
(IP Routed Subnet dns same as NAT Subnet dns)
Syntax
srv dhcp dns2 [?]
srv dhcp dns2 [DNS IP address]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display current IP address of DNS 2 for the DHCP server.
DNS IP address It means the IP address that you want to use as DNS2.
Note: The IP Routed Subnet DNS must be the same as NAT Subnet
DNS).
Example
> srv dhcp dns2 10.1.1.1
% srv dhcp dns2 <DNS IP address>
% Now: 10.1.1.1
(IP Routed Subnet dns same as NAT Subnet dns)
Syntax
srv dhcp frcdnsmanl [on]
srv dhcp frcdnsmanl [off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display the current status.
on It means to use manual setting for DNS setting.
Off It means to use auto settings acquired from ISP.
Example
Syntax
srv dhcp gateway [?]
srv dhcp gateway [Gateway IP]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display current gateway that you can use.
Gateway IP It means to specify a gateway address used for DHCP server.
Example
> srv dhcp gateway 192.168.2.1
This setting will take effect after rebooting.
Please use "sys reboot" command to reboot the router.
Syntax
srv dhcp ipcnt [?]
srv dhcp ipcnt [IP counts]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display current used IP count number.
IP counts It means the number that you have to specify for the DHCP server.
Example
> srv dhcp ipcnt ?
% srv dhcp ipcnt <IP counts>
% Now: 150
Syntax
srv dhcp relay servip [server ip]
srv dhcp relay subnet [index]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
server ip It means the IP address that you want to used as DHCP server.
Index It means subnet 1 or 2. Please type 1 or 2. The router will invoke
this function according to the subnet 1 or 2 specified here.
Example
> srv dhcp relay servip 192.168.1.46
> srv dhcp relay subnet 2
> srv dhcp relay servip ?
% srv dhcp relay servip <server ip>
% Now: 192.168.1.46
Syntax
srv dhcp startip [?]
srv dhcp startip [IP address]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display current used start IP address.
IP address It means the IP address that you can specify for the DHCP server as
the starting point.
Example
> srv dhcp startip 192.168.1.53
This setting will take effect after rebooting.
Please use "sys reboot" command to reboot the router.
Example
> srv dhcp status
DHCP server: Relay Agent
Default gateway: 192.168.1.1
Index IP Address MAC Address Leased Time HOST ID
1 192.168.1.113 00-05-5D-E4-D8-EE 17:20:08 A1000351
Syntax
srv dhcp leasetime [?]
srv dhcp leasetime [Lease Time (sec)]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
? It means to display current leasetime used for the DHCP server.
Lease Time (sec) It means the lease time that DHCP server can use. The unit is
second.
Example
> srv dhcp leasetime ?
% srv dhcp leasetime <Lease Time (sec.)>
% Now: 86400
>
Syntax
srv dhcp nodetype <count>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
count It means to specify a type for node.
1. B-node
2. P-node
4. M-node
8. H-node
Example
> srv dhcp nodetype 1
> srv dhcp nodetype ?
%% srv dhcp nodetype <count>
%% 1. B-node 2. P-node 4. M-node 8. H-node
% Now: 1
Syntax
srv dhcp primWINS [WINS IP address]
srv dhcp primWINS clear
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
WINS IP address It means the IP address of primary WINS server.
clear It means to remove the IP address settings of primary WINS server.
Example
> srv dhcp primWINS 192.168.1.88
> srv dhcp primWINS ?
%% srv dhcp primWINS <WINS IP address>
%% srv dhcp primWINS clear
% Now: 192.168.1.88
Syntax
srv dhcp secWINS [WINS IP address]
srv dhcp secWINS clear
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
WINS IP address It means the IP address of secondary WINS server.
clear It means to remove the IP address settings of second WINS server.
Example
> srv dhcp secWINS 192.168.1.180
> srv dhcp secWINS ?
%% srv dhcp secWINS <WINS IP address>
%% srv dhcp secWINS clear
% Now: 192.168.1.180
Syntax
srv dhcp expRecycleIP <sec time>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
sec time It means to set the time (5~300 seconds) for checking if the IP can be
assigned again or not.
Example
Vigor> srv dhcp expRecycleIP 250
% DHCP expired_RecycleIP = 250
Syntax
srv dhcp tftp <TFTP server name>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
TFTP server name It means to type the name of TFTP server.
Example
> srv dhcp tftp TF123
> srv dhcp tftp ?
%% srv dhcp tftp <TFTP server name>
% Now: TF123
Syntax
srv dhcp option -h
srv dhcp option -l
srv dhcp option -d [idx]
srv dhcp option -e [1 or 0] -c [option number] -v [option value]
srv dhcp option -e [1 or 0] -c [option number] -a [option value]
srv dhcp option -e [1 or 0] -c [option number] -x [option value]
srv dhcp option -u [idx unmber]
Syntax Description
Example
> srv dhcp option -e 1 -c 18 -v /path
> srv dhcp option -l
% state idx interface opt type data
Syntax
srv nat dmz n m [-<command> <parameter> | … ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
n It means to map selected WAN IP to certain host.
1: wan1
2: wan2
m It means the index number of the DMZ host.
Default setting is “1” (WAN 1). It is only available for Static IP
mode. If you use other mode, you can set 1 ~ 8 in this field. If WAN
IP alias has been configured, then the number of DMZ host can be
added more.
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-e It means to enable/disable such feature.
1:enable
0:disable
-i It means to specify the private IP address of the DMZ host.
-r It means to remove DMZ host setting.
-v It means to display current status.
Example
> srv nat dmz 1 1 -i 192.168.1.96
> srv nat dmz -v
% WAN1 DMZ mapping status:
Index Status WAN1 aux IP Private IP
----------------------------------------------------
1 Disable 0.0.0.0 192.168.1.96
Syntax
srv nat ipsecpass [options]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
[options] The available commands with parameters are listed below.
on It means to enable IPSec ESP tunnel passthrough and IKE source port
(500) preservation.
off It means to disable IPSec ESP tunnel passthrough and IKE source
port (500) preservation.
Example
> srv nat ipsecpass status
%% Status: IPsec ESP pass-thru and IKE src_port:500 preservation is
OFF.
Syntax
srv nat openport n m [-<command> <parameter> | … ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
n It means the index number for the profiles. The range is from 1 to
20.
m It means to specify the sub-item number for this profile. The range
is from 1 to 10.
[<command> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
<parameter>|…] […] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-a <enable> It means to enable or disable the open port rule profile.
0: disable
1:enable
-c <comment> It means to type the description (less than 23 characters) for the
defined network service.
-i <local ip> It means to set the IP address for local computer.
Local ip: Type an IP address in this field.
-w <idx> It means to specify the public IP.
1: WAN1 Default,
2: WAN1 Alias 1,
…and so on.
-p <protocol> Specify the transport layer protocol.
Available values are TCP, UDP and ALL.
-s<start port> It means to specify the starting port number of the service offered
by the local host. The range is from 0 to 65535.
-e<end port> It means to specify the ending port number of the service offered by
the local host.
The range is from 0 to 65535.
-v It means to display current settings.
-r <remove> It means to delete the specified open port setting.
remove: Type the index number of the profile.
-f <flush> It means to return to factory settings for all the open ports profiles.
Example
> srv nat openport 1 1 -a 1 -c games -i 192.168.1.100 -w 1 -p TCP -s
23 -e 83
> srv nat openport -v
%% Status: Disable
%% Comment:
%% Private IP address: 0.0.0.0
Index Protocal Start Port End Port
*****************************************************************
%% Status: Disable
%% Comment:
%% Private IP address: 0.0.0.0
Index Protocal Start Port End Port
*****************************************************************
>
Syntax
srv nat portmap add [idx][serv name][proto][pub port][pri ip][pri port][wan1/wan2]
srv nat portmap del [idx]
srv nat portmap disable [idx]
srv nat portmap enable [idx] [proto]
srv nat portmap flush
srv nat portmap table
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Add[idx] It means to add a new port redirection table with an index number.
Available index number is from 1 to 10.
serv name It means to type one name as service name.
proto It means to specify TCP or UDP as the protocol.
pub port It means to specify which port can be redirected to the specified
Private IP and Port of the internal host.
pri ip It means to specify the private IP address of the internal host
providing the service.
pri port It means to specify the private port number of the service offered
by the internal host.
wan1/wan2 It means to specify WAN interface for the port redirection.
del [idx] It means to remove the selected port redirection setting.
disable [idx] It means to inactivate the selected port redirection setting.
enable [idx] It means to activate the selected port redirection setting.
flush It means to clear all the port mapping settings.
Example
> srv nat portmap add 1 game tcp 80 192.168.1.11 100 wan1
> srv nat portmap table
19 0 0 0 -2
20 0 0 0 -2
Example
> srv nat status
NAT Port Redirection Running Table:
20 0 0 0.0.0.0 0
--- MORE --- ['q': Quit, 'Enter': New Lines, 'Space Bar': Next Page]
---
Example
> srv nat showall ?
Index Proto WAN IP:Port Private IP:Port Act
*************************************************************************
****
R01 TCP 0.0.0.0:80 192.168.1.11:100 Y
Syntax
switch -i [switch idx_no] [option]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
switch idx_no It means the index number of the switch profile.
option The available commands with parameters are listed below.
cmd
acc
Example
> switch -i 1 traffic on
External Device NO. 1 traffic statistic function is enable
Example
> switch on
Enable Extrnal Device auto discovery!
Example
> switch off
Disable External Device auto discovery!
Example
> switch list?
No. Mac IP status Dur Time Model_Name
------------------------------------------------------------------
---------
[1] 00-50-7f-cd-07-48 192.168.1.3 On-Line 00:01:01
Vigor2920 Series
Syntax
switch clear [idx]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
idx It means the index number of each item shown on the table.
The range is from 1 to 8.
-f It means to clear all of the data.
Example
> switch query on
Extern Device status query is Enable
> switch query off
Extern Device status query is Disable
Syntax
sys adminuser [option]
sys adminuser edit [index] username password
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
option Available options includes:
Local [0-1]
LDAP [0-1]
edit [INDEX]
delete [INDEX]
view [INDEX]
Local [0-1] 0 – Disable the local user.
1 – Enable the local user.
LDAP [0-1] 0 – Disable the LDAP.
1 – Enable the LDAP.
edit [INDEX] username Edit an existed user account or create a new local user account.
password [INDEX] – 1 ~8. There are eight profiles to be added / edited.
Username – Type a new name for local user.
Password – Type a password for local user.
delete [INDEX] Delete a local user account.
view [INDEX] Show the user account/password detail information.
Example
> > sys adminuser Local 1
Index:1
User Name:carrie
User Password:test123
Syntax
sys bonjour [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-e <enable> It is used to disable/enable bonjour service (0: disable, 1: enable).
-h <enable> It is used to disable/enable http (web) service (0: disable, 1:
enable).
-t <enable> It is used to disable/enable telnet service (0: disable, 1: enable).
-f <enable> It is used to disable/enable FTP service (0: disable, 1: enable).
-s <enable> It is used to disable/enable SSH service (0: disable, 1: enable).
-p <enable> It is used to disable/enable printer service (0: disable, 1: enable).
-6 <enable> It is used to disable/enable IPv6 (0: disable, 1: enable).
Example
> sys bonjour -s 1
>
Syntax
sys cfg default
sys cfg status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
default It means to reset current settings with default values.
status It means to display current profile version and status.
Example
> sys cfg status
Profile version: 3.0.0 Status: 1 (0x491e5e6c)
> sys cfg default
>
Example
> sys cmdlog
% Commands Log: (The lowest index is the newest !!!)
[1] sys cmdlog
[2] sys cmdlog ?
[3] sys ?
[4] sys cfg status
[5] sys cfg ?
Syntax
sys ftpd on
sys ftpd off
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on It means to turn on the FTP server of the system.
off It means to turn off the FTP server of the system.
Example
> sys ftpd on
% sys ftpd turn on !!!
Syntax
sys domainname [wan1/wan2] [Domain Name Suffix]
sys domainname [wan1/wan2] clear
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
wan1/wan2 It means to specify WAN interface for assigning a name for it.
Domain Name Suffix It means the name for the domain of the system. The maximum
number of characters that you can set is 40.
clear It means to remove the domain name of the system.
Example
> sys domainname wan1 clever
> sys domainname wan2 intellegent
> sys domainname ?
% sys domainname <wan1/wan2> <Domain Name Suffix (max. 40 characters)>
% sys domainname <wan1/wan2> clear
% Now: wan1 == clever, wan2 ==intelligent
>
Example
> sys iface
Interface 0 Ethernet:
Status: UP
IP Address: 192.168.1.1 Netmask: 0xFFFFFF00 (Private)
IP Address: 0.0.0.0 Netmask: 0xFFFFFFFF
MAC: 00-50-7F-00-00-00
Interface 4 Ethernet:
Status: DOWN
IP Address: 0.0.0.0 Netmask: 0x00000000
MAC: 00-50-7F-00-00-02
Interface 5 Ethernet:
Status: DOWN
IP Address: 0.0.0.0 Netmask: 0x00000000
MAC: 00-50-7F-00-00-03
Interface 6 Ethernet:
Status: DOWN
IP Address: 0.0.0.0 Netmask: 0x00000000
MAC: 00-50-7F-00-00-04
Interface 9 Ethernet:
Status: DOWN
IP Address: 0.0.0.0 Netmask: 0x00000000
MAC: 00-50-7F-00-00-07
--- MORE --- ['q': Quit, 'Enter': New Lines, 'Space Bar': Next Page]
---
>
Syntax
sys name [wan1] [ASCII string]
sys name [wan1] clear
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
wan1 It means to specify WAN interface for assigning a name for it.
ASCII string It means the name for router. The maximum character that you can
set is 20.
Example
> sys name wan1 drayrouter
> sys name ?
% sys name <wan1/wan2> <ASCII string (max. 20 characters)>
% sys name <wan1/wan2> clear
% Now: wan1 == drayrouter, wan2 ==
Note: Such name can be used to recognize router’s identification in SysLog dialog.
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ASCII string It means the password for administrator. The maximum character
that you can set is 23.
Example
> sys passwd admin123
>
Example
> sys reboot
>
Syntax
sys autoreboot [on/off/hour(s)]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on/off On – It means to enable the function of auto-reboot.
Off – It means to disable the function of auto-reboot.
hours It means to set the time schedule for router reboot.
For example, if you type “2” in this field, the router will reboot
with an interval of two hours.
Example
> sys autoreboot on
autoreboot is ON
> sys autoreboot 2
autoreboot is ON
autoreboot time is 2 hour(s)
Example
> sys commit
Example
> sys tftpd
% TFTP server enabled !!!
Example
> sys cc
Country Code : 0x 0 [International]
Wireless Region Code: 0x30
>
Example
> sys version
Router Model: Vigor2860Vn+ Version: 3.7.4.1 English
Profile version: 3.0.0 Status: 1 (0x49165e6c)
Router IP: 192.168.1.1 Netmask: 255.255.255.0
Firmware Build Date/Time: Mar 20 2014 14:09:50
Router Name: drayrouter
Revision: 40055 2860_374
VDSL2 Firmware Version: 05-04-08-00-00-06
Example
> sys qrybuf
System Memory Status and Leakage List
Syntax
sys pollbuf [on]
sys pollbuf [off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on It means to turn on pulling buffer.
off It means to turn off pulling buffer.
Example
> sys pollbuf on
% Buffer polling is on!
Syntax
sys britask [on]
sys britask [off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on It means to turn on the bridge task for improving the triple play
quality.
off It means to turn off the bridge task.
Example
> sys britask on
% bridge task is ON, now
Syntax
sys tr069 get [parm] [option]
sys tr069 set [parm] [value]
sys tr069 getnoti [parm]
sys tr069 setnoti [parm] [value]
sys tr069 log
sys tr069 debug [on/off]
sys tr069 save
sys tr069 inform [event code]
sys tr069 port [port num]
sys tr069 cert_auth [on/off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
get [parm] [option] It means to get parameters for tr-069.
option=<nextlevel>: only gets nextlevel for GetParameterNames.
set [parm] [value] It means to set parameters for tr-069.
getnoti [parm] It means to get parameter notification value.
setnoti [parm] [value] It means to set parameter notification value.
log It means to display the TR-069 log.
debug [on/off] on: turn on the function of sending debug message to syslog.
off: turn off the function of sending debug message to syslog.
save It means to save the parameters to the flash memory of the router.
Inform [event code] It means to inform parameters for tr069 with different event codes.
[event code] includes:
0-"0 BOOTSTRAP",
1-"1 BOOT",
2-"2 PERIODIC",
3-"3 SCHEDULED",
4-"4 VALUE CHANGE",
5-"5 KICKED",
6-"6 CONNECTION REQUEST",
7-"7 TRANSFER COMPLETE",
8-"8 DIAGNOSTICS COMPLETE",
9-"M Reboot"
port [port num] It means to change tr069 listen port number.
cert_auth [on/off] on: turn on certificate-based authentication.
off: turn off certificate-based authentication.
Example
> sys tr069 get Int. nextlevel
Total number of parameter is 24
InternetGatewayDevice.X_00507F_Diagnostics.
--- MORE --- ['q': Quit, 'Enter': New Lines, 'Space Bar': Next Page]
---
Syntax
sys sip_alg [1]
sys sip_alg [0]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
1 It means to turn on SIP ALG.
0 It means to turn off SIP ALG.
Example
> sys sip_alg ?
usage: sys sip_alg [value]
0 - disable SIP ALG
1 - enable SIP ALG
current SIP ALG is disabled
Syntax
sys license licmsg
sys license licauth
sys license regser
sys license licera
sys license licifno
sys license lic_wiz [set/reg/qry]
sys license dev_chg
sys license dev_key
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
licmsg It means to display license message.
licauth It means the license authentication time setting.
regser It means the license register server setting.
licera It means to erase license setting.
licifno It means license and signature download interface setting.
lic_wiz [set/reg/qry] It means the license wizard setting.
qry: query service support status
set [idx] [trial] [service type] [sp_id] [start_date] [License Key]
reg: register service in portal
dev_chg It means to change the device key.
dev_key It means to show device key.
Example
> sys license licifno
Syntax
sys diag_log [status| enable| disable| flush| lineno [w] | level [x] | feature [on|off] [y]|
log]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
status It means to show the status of diagnostic log.
enable It means to enable the function of diag_log.
disable It means to disenable the function of diag_log.
flush It means the flush log buffer.
lineno [w] It means the total lines for displaying message.
w - Available value ranges from 100 to 50000.
level[x] It determines the level of data displayed.
x – Available value ranges from 0 to 12. The larger the number is,
the detailed the data is displayed.
feature [on/off][y] It is used to specify the function of the log. Supported features
include SYS and DSL (Case-Insensitive). Default setting is “on” for
“DSL”.
voip_feature It means VoIP feature. Type on to enable the feature or type off to
[on/off][vf_name] disable the feature.
vf_name: available settings include DRVTAPI, DRVVMMC, DRVMPS,
DRVFXO, DRVHAL, PSMPHONE, PSMSUPP, PSM, FXO, PSMISDN,
DTMFPSER, CALLERID (Case-Insensitive).
log It means the dump log buffer.
Example
> sys diag_log status
Status:
diag_log is Enabled.
lineno : 10000.
level : 3.
Enabled feature: SYS DSL
> sys diag_log log
0:00:02 [DSL] Current modem firmware: AnnexA_548006_544401
0:00:02 [DSL] Modem firmware feature: 5, ADSL_A, VDSL2
0:00:02 [DSL] xtseCfg=04 00 04 00 0c 01 00 07
0:00:02 [DSL] don't have last showtime mode!! set next mode to VDSL!!
0:00:02 [DSL] Status has changed: Stopped(0) -> FwWait(3)
0:00:02 [DSL] Status has changed: FwWait(3) -> Starting(1)
0:00:02 [DSL] Status has changed: Starting(1) -> Running(2)
0:00:02 [DSL] Status was switched: firmwareReady(3) to Init(5)
0:00:02 [DSL] Status was switched: Init(5) to Restart(10)
0:00:02 [DSL] Status was switched: Restart(10) to
FirmwareRequest(1)
0:00:02 [DSL] Line state has changed: 00000000 -> 000000FF
0:00:02 [DSL] Entering VDSL2 mode
Example
> testmail
Send out test mail
Mail Alert:[Disable]
SMTP_Server:[0.0.0.0]
Mail to:[]
Return-Path:[]
Example
>upnp off
UPNP say bye-bye
Example
>upnp on
UPNP start.
Example
> upnp nat ?
****************** IGD NAT Status ****************
((0))
InternalClient >>192.168.1.10<<, RemoteHost >>0.0.0.0<<
InternalPort >>21<<, ExternalPort >>21<<
PortMapProtocol >>TCP<<
--- MORE --- ['q': Quit, 'Enter': New Lines, 'Space Bar': Next Page] ---
Example
> upnp on
UPNP start.
Example
> upnp on
UPNP start.
> upnp subscribe
sid = 7a2bbdd0-0047-4fc8-b870-4597b34da7fb
expireTime =6926
active =1
DeliveryURLs
=<http://192.168.1.113:2869/upnp/eventing/twtnpnsiun>
sid = d9cd47a5-d9c9-4d3d-8043-d03a82f27983
Example
Vigor> upnp tmpvs
****************** Temp virtual server status ****************
((0))
real_addr >>192.168.1.10<<, pseudo_addr >>172.16.3.229<<
real_port >>0<<, pseudo_port >>0<<
hit_portmap_index >>0<<
The protocol >>TCP<<
time >>0<<
((1))
real_addr >>0.0.0.0<<, pseudo_addr >>0.0.0.0<<
real_port >>0<<, pseudo_port >>0<<
hit_portmap_index >>0<<
The protocol >>0<<
time >>0<<
--- MORE --- ['q': Quit, 'Enter': New Lines, 'Space Bar': Next Page]
---
Syntax
upnp wan [n]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
n It means to specify WAN interface to apply UPnP.
n=0, it means to auto-select WAN interface.
n=1, WAN1
n=2, WAN2 ……….
Example
> upnp wan 1
use wan1 now.
Example
> usb list ?
Brand Module Standard
------------------------ --------
Aiko Aiko 83D 3.5G Y
BandRich Bandluxe C170 3.5G Y
BandRich Bandluxe C270 3.5G Y
BandRich Bandluxe C321 3.5G Y
BandRich Bandluxe C330 3.5G Y
BandRich Bandluxe C331 3.5G Y
BandRich Bandluxe C502 3.5G Y
Huawei Huawei E169u 3.5G Y
Huawei Huawei E220 3.5G Y
Huawei Huawei E303D 3.5G Y
Huawei Huawei E392 3.5G Y
Huawei Huawei E398 3.5G Y
Sony Erics Sony Ericsson MD30 3.5G Y
TP-LINK TP-LINK MA180 3.5G Y
TP-LINK TP-LINK MA260 3.5G Y
Vodafone Vodafone K3765-Z 3.5G Y
Vodafone Vodafone K4605 3.5G Y
ZTE ZTE MF626 3.5G Y
ZTE ZTE MF627 plus 3.5G Y
ZTE ZTE MF633 3.5G Y
ZTE ZTE MF636 3.5G Y
Example
> vigbrg on
%Enable Vigor Bridge Function!
Example
> vigbrg off
%Disable Vigor Bridge Function!
Example
> vigbrg status
%Vigor Bridge Function is enable!
Syntax
vigbrg cfgip [IP Address]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
IP Address It means to type an IP address for users to manage the router.
Example
> vigbrg cfgip 192.168.1.15
> vigbrg cfgip ?
% Vigor Bridge Config IP,
% Now: 192.168.1.15
Example
> vigbrg wan1on
%Enable Vigor Bridge Wan1 management!
Example
> vigbrg wan1off
%Disable Vigor Bridge Wan1 management!
Syntax
voip debug [flush]
voip debug [showmsg]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
flush It means to clear current log.
showmsg It means to show current log.
Example
> voip debug showmsg
v=0
o=change_me 5972727 56415 IN IP4 192.168.1.1
Syntax
voip dialplan block n [-<command><parameter>]
voip dialplan phonebook n [-<command><parameter>]
voip dialplan region [-<command><parameter>]
voip dialplan local [1/0]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
voip dialplan block
n It means the index number of the VoIP settings.
n=1 ~ 20
-<command><parameter> The available commands with parameters are listed below.
-m 0/1 It means to enable or disable the block mode.
0 – Disable
1 - Enable
-p <path> Determines the block path.
1:in_url,
2:in_number
3:out_url,
4:out_number
5:(in & out)_url,
6:(in & out)_number) )
-n <number> Determines the block number (maximum 29 characters).
-d <domain> Block the specified domain.
-i <inf> Block the specified interface(s) or All interfaces.
-s <Schedule> Specify schedule profiles by indicating the index number of the
schedule profile. Four schedule profiles can be used at one time.
-w Delete the selected entry. N=null (clear all)
Example
> voip dialplan phonebook 1 -d 1125
> voip dialplan region -l 8
> voip dialplan region -v
Your Setting for Regional
Regional Function is: Enable
Return the Last Miss Call: 20
Return the Last Incoming Call: *12
Return the Last Outgoing Call: 1
Hotkey to enable call forwarding (all) function: 0
Hotkey to enable call forwarding (busy) function: *90
Hotkey to enable call forwarding (no answer) function: *92
Hotkey to disable call forwarding function: 12
Hotkey to Enable Call Waiting Function: *56
Hotkey to Disable Call Waiting Function: *57
Hotkey to Enable Hide Caller ID Function: *67
Hotkey to Disable Hide Caller ID Function: *68
Hotkey to Enable DND Function: *78
Hotkey to Disable DND Function: *79
Hotkey to Enable Block Anonymous Calls Function: *77
Hotkey to Disable Block Anonymous Calls Function: *87
Hotkey to Enable Block Unknow Domain Calls Function: *40
Hotkey to Disable Block Unknow Domain Calls Function: *04
Hotkey to Enable Block IP Calls Function: *50
Hotkey to Disable Block IP Calls Function: *05
Hotkey to Disable Block The Last Incoming Call Function: 8
Syntax
voip dsp countrytone [channel] [value]
voip dsp dialtonepwr [channel] [AbsoluteValue]
voip dsp EchoCanceller [type] [w_size] [nlp]
voip dsp cidtype [channel] [value]
voip dsp micgain [channel] [value/(1~10)]
voip dsp spkgain [channel] [value/(1~10)]
voip dsp jitterBuffer [port] [mode] [value]
voip dsp dtmfDetset [nLevel] [nTwist]
voip dsp dtmftonepwr [Level]
voip dsp cwtonepwr [ch] [value]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
voip dsp countrytone
[channel] [value] This command allows users to set the region for the tone settings.
Different regions usually need different tone settings.
Channel – 1 or 2.
Value – displayed as follows:
[2] UK, [3] USA, [4] Denmark, [5] Italy, [6] Germany,
[7] Netherlands, [8] Portugal, [9] Sweden, [10] Australia,
[11] Slovenia, [12] Czech, [13] Slovakia, [14] Hungary,
[15] Switzerland , [16] France , [17] Malta
voip dsp dialtonepwr
channel This setting is used to adjust the loudness of the dial tone. The
smaller the number is, the louder the dial tone is. It is
recommended for you to use the default setting.
Channel - Available channel number: 1 – 2
AbsoluteValue AbsoluteValue - In -1 dB increments, with 1 corresponding to 6 dBm.
Range - 1 to 30
voip dsp EchoCanceler
type This command is used to set the type of echo reduction.
0 - Disable the LEC processing.
1 - Cancel using the fixed window.
2 - Cancel using the fixed and moving window.
3 - Cancel using fixed window + Echo Suppressor.
w_size The Line Echo Canceller (LEC) window size is 4, 6, 8 or 16 (ms).
nlp Nlp - Non-linear processing (NLP) for more smooth transitions.
1 - disable
0 - enable
voip dsp cidtype
channel Set the caller ID type for FXS 1 (Channel 1) or FXS 2 (Channel 2).
1 – FXS 1
2 – FXS 2
value Each number (1 to 6) represents different type.
1 – FSK_ETSI
2 - FSK_ETSI(UK)
3 - FSK_BELLCORE(US/AU)
4 - DTMF
5 - DTMF(Dk)
6 - DTMF(SE,NL,FIN)
For example :
Example
> voip dsp countrytone ?
VoIP has been disable. Please enable VoIP first.
Syntax
voip rtp codec [sip acc index][type|size|vad|one][value]
voip rtp dtmf [index] [mode|payloadtype][value]
voip rtp port [start|end] [value]
voip rtp symmetric [value]
voip rtp tos ?
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
voip rtp codec
[sip acc Set the voice coding.
index][type|size|vad|one][v sip acc index –SIP account index number. Available number, 1 ~ 12.
alue]
type – Available settings include
0. G.711MU
1. G.711A
2. G.729A/B
3. G.723
4. G.726_32
size - Five options,
0 means 10ms
Example
> voip rtp codec 1 type 3
> voip rtp dtmf 2 mode 3
> voip rtp port start 10070 end 14400
Set start port: 10070
> voip rtp port end 14400
Set end port: 14400
> voip rtp symmetric 1
Set symmetric rtp to Enable
Syntax
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
voip sip acc - Allows users to set SIP account.
n n = 1 to 12
It means the index number of the VoIP settings.
-P [profile] It means the name of the account profile (maximum 11 characters).
-r [reg mode] Set registration mode for SIP account.
0 – none
1 – auto
2 - wan1 only
3 - wan2 only
4 - lan/vpn
5 – PVC
6 - wan3 only
7 - wan4 only
8 - wan1 first
9 - wan2 first
10 - wan3 first
11 - wan4 first
-o [port] Set the port number for sending/receiving SIP message for building
a session. The default value is 5060.
-d [domain] Set the domain name or IP address of the SIP Registrar server. The
maximum is 63 characters.
-y [proxy] Set domain name or IP address of SIP proxy server. The maximum is
63 characters.
-b [enable] Enable / disable outbound proxy by SIP account.
0 – disable
1 - enable
-s [enable] Enable / disable to locate SIP server (rfc 3263).
0 – disable
1 - enable
-N [name] Set SIP account display name.
Name - max. 23 characters.
-n [number] Set SIP account number.
Number - max. 63 characters.
-a [id] Set SIP authentication ID.
Id - max. 63 characters.
-A [enable] Enable /disable to use SIP authentication ID.
0 – disable
1 - enable
-p [passwd] Set SIP account password (max. 63 characters).
-e [sec] Set expiry time (default 3600) for SIP account.
-w [enable] Enable to make phone call without registering.
-m [mode] Set NAT traversal mode.
Example
> voip sip misc -t 1
includes User-Agent header
Syntax
voip secure general [-<command> <parameter> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
voip secure general -e Enable / disable secure phone feature.
0 - disable
1 - enable
voip secure general -p Enable /disable SAS voice prompt.
0 - disable
1 - enable
voip secure general -v view only secure phone general settings
Example
> voip secure general -v
secure phone feature is disabled
SAS voice prompt is enabled
> voip secure general -p 0
SAS voice prompt is disabled
Syntax
vpn l2lset [list index] peerid [peerid]
vpn l2lset [list index] localid [localid]
vpn l2lset [list index]main [auto/proposal index]
vpn l2lset [list index] aggressive [g1/g2]
vpn l2lset [list index]pfs [on/off]
vpn l2lset [list index] phase1[lifetime]
vpn l2lset [list index] phase2[lifetime]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
list index It means the index number of L2L (LAN to LAN) profile.
peerid It means the peer identity for aggressive mode.
localid It means the local identity for aggressive mode.
main It means to choose proposal for main mode.
Example
> VPN l2lset 1 peerid 10226
Example
> vpn l2lDrop
>
Syntax
vpn dinset <list index>
vpn dinset <list index> <on/off>
vpn dinset <list index> motp <on/off>
vpn dinset <list index> pin_secret <pin> <secret>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
<list index> It means the index number of the profile.
<on/off> It means to enable or disable the profile.
on – Enable.
off – Disable.
motp <on/off> It means to enable or disable the authentication with mOTP
function.
on – Enable.
off – Disable.
pin_secret<pin> <secret> It means to set PIN code with secret.
<pin> - Type the code for authentication (e.g, 1234).
<secret> - Use the 32 digit-secret number generated by mOTP in the
mobile phone (e.g., e759bb6f0e94c7ab4fe6)
Example
> vpn dinset 1
Password:
PIN: 1234
Secret: e759bb6f0e94c7ab4fe6
Syntax
vpn subnet [index] [1/2/3/4/5/6]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
<index> It means the index number of the VPN profile.
<1/2/3/4/5/6> 1 – it means LAN1
2 – it means LAN2.
3 – it means LAN3
4 – it means LAN4.
5 – it means LAN51
6 – it means LAN6.
Syntax
Command of PPTP Dial-Out
vpn setup <index> <name> pptp_out <ip> <usr> <pwd> <nip> <nmask>
Command of IPSec Dial-Out
vpn setup <index> <name> ipsec_out <ip> <key> <nip> <nmask>
Command of L2Tp Dial-Out
vpn setup <index> <name> l2tp_out <ip> <usr> <pwd> <nip> <nmask>
Command of Dial-In
vpn setup <index> <name> dialin <ip> <usr> <pwd> <key> <nip> <nmask>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
For PPTP Dial-Out
<index> It means the index number of the profile.
<name> It means the name of the profile.
<ip> It means the IP address to dial to.
<usr> <pwd> It means the user and the password required for the PPTP
connection.
<nip> <nmask> It means the remote network IP and the mask.
e.g.,
vpn setup 1 name1 pptp_out 1.2.3.4 vigor 1234 192.168.1.0
255.255.255.0
For IPsec Dial-Out
<index> It means the index number of the profile.
<name> It means the name of the profile.
<ip> It means the IP address to dial to.
<key> It means the value of IPsec Pre-Shared Key.
<nip> <nmask> It means the remote network IP and the mask.
e.g.,
vpn setup 1 name1 ipsec_out 1.2.3.4 1234 192.168.1.0
255.255.255.0
For L2TP Dial-Out
<index> It means the index number of the profile.
<name> It means the name of the profile.
<ip> It means the IP address to dial to.
<usr> <pwd> It means the user and the password required for the L2TP
connection.
<nip> <nmask> It means the remote network IP and the mask.
Example
> vpn setup 1 name1 dialin 1.2.3.4 vigor 1234 abc 192.168.1.0
255.255.255.0
% Profile Change Log ...
% Profile Index : 1
% Profile Name : name1
% Username : vigor
% Password : 1234
% Pre-share Key : abc
% Call Direction : Dial-In
% Type of Server : ISDN PPTP IPSec L2TP
% Dial from : 1.2.3.4
% Remote NEtwork IP : 192.168.1.0
% Remote NEtwork Mask : 255.255.255.0
>
Syntax
vpn option <index> <cmd1>=<param1> [<cmd2>=<para2> | ... ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
<index> It means the index number of the profile.
Available index numbers:
1 ~ 32
For Common Settings
<index> It means the index number of the profile.
pname It means the name of the profile.
ena It means to enable or disable the profile.
Example
> vpn option 1 idle=250
% Change Log..
Syntax
vpn mroute <index> list
vpn mroute <index> add <network ip>/<mask>
vpn mroute <index> del <network ip>/<mask>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
list It means to display all of the route settings.
add It means to add a new route.
del It means to delete specified route.
<index> It means the index number of the profile.
Available index numbers:
1 ~ 32
<network ip>/<mask> Type the IP address with the network mask address.
Example
> vpn mroute 1 add 192.168.5.0/24
% 192.168.5.0/24
% Add new route 192.168.5.0/24 to profile 1
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
all It means to list configuration of the specified profile.
com It means to list common settings of the specified profile.
out It means to list dial-out settings of the specified profile.
in It means to list dial-in settings of the specified profile.
net It means to list Network Settings of the specified profile.
<index> It means the index number of the profile.
Available index numbers:
1 ~ 32
Example
> vpn list 32 all
% Common Settings
% Dial-out Settings
% Dial-In Settings
--- MORE --- ['q': Quit, 'Enter': New Lines, 'Space Bar': Next Page] ---
> vpn list 1 com
Syntax
vpn remote [PPTP/IPSec/L2TP] [on/off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
PPTP/IPSec/L2TP There are four types to be selected.
on/off on – enable VPN remote setting.
off – disable VPN remote setting.
Example
> vpn remote PPTP on
Set PPTP VPN Service : On
Syntax
vpn 2ndsubnet on
vpn 2ndsubnet off
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on/off It means to enable or disable second subnet.
Example
> vpn 2ndsubnet on
%Enable second subnet IP as VPN server IP!
Syntax
vpn NetBios set <H2l/L2l> <index> <Block/Pass>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
<H2l/L2l> H2l means Remote Access User Accounts.
L2l means LAN-to-LAN Profile.
Specify which one will be applied by NetBios.
<index> The index number of the profile.
<Block/Pass> Pass – Have an inquiry for data transmission between the hosts
located on both sides of VPN Tunnel while connecting.
Block – When there is conflict occurred between the hosts on both
sides of VPN Tunnel in connecting, set it block data transmission of
Netbios Naming Packet inside the tunnel.
Example
> vpn NetBios set H2l 1 Pass
% Remote Dial In Profile Index [1] :
% NetBios Block/Pass: [PASS]
Syntax
vpn mss show
vpn mss default
vpn mss set <connection type> <TCP maximum segment size range>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show It means to display current setting status.
default TCP maximum segment size for all the VPN connection will be set as
1360 bytes.
set Use it to specify the connection type and value of MSS.
<connection type> 1~4 represent various type.
1 – PPTP
2 – L2TP
3 – IPSec
4 – L2TP over IPSec
<TCP maximum segment size Each type has different segment size range.
range> PPTP – 1 ~ 1412
L2TP – 1 ~ 1408
IPSec – 1 ~ 1381
Example
>vpn mss set 1 1400
% VPN TCP maximum segment size (MSS) :
PPTP = 1400
L2TP = 1360
IPSec = 1360
L2TP over IPSec = 1360
>vpn mss show
VPN TCP maximum segment size (MSS) :
PPTP = 1400
L2TP = 1360
IPSec = 1360
L2TP over IPSec = 1360
Syntax
vpn ike -q
Example
> vpn ike -q
IKE Memory Status and Leakage List
Syntax
vpn Multicast set <H2l/L2l> <index> <Block/Pass>
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
<H2l/L2l> H2l means Host to LAN (Remote Access User Accounts).
L2l means LAN-to-LAN Profile.
<index> The index number of the profile.
<Block/Pass> Set Block/Pass the Multicast Packets.
The default is Block.
Example
Syntax
vpn pass2nd[on]
vpn pass2nd [off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on/off on – the packets can pass through NAT.
off – the packets cannot pass through NAT.
Example
> vpn pass2nd on
% 2nd subnet is allowed to pass VPN tunnel!
Syntax
vpn pass2nat [on]
vpn pass2nat [off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on/off on – the packets can pass through NAT.
off – the packets cannot pass through NAT.
Example
> vpn pass2nat on
% Packets would go through by NAT when VPN disconnect!!
Syntax
wan ppp_mru <WAN interface number> <MRU size >
Example
>wan ppp_mru 1 ?
% Now: 1492
Syntax
wan mtu [value]
wan mtu2 [value]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
value It means the number of MTU for PPP. The available range is from
1000 to 1500.
For Static IP/DHCP, the maximum number will be 1500.
For PPPoE, the maximum number will be 1492.
For PPTP/L2TP, the maximum number will be 1460.
Example
> wan mtu 1100
> wan mtu ?
Static IP/DHCP (Max MSS: 1500)
PPPoE(Max MSS: 1492)
PPTP/L2TP(Max MSS: 1460)
% wan ppp_mss <MSS size: 1000 ~ 1500>
% Now: 1100
Syntax
wan DF_check [on]
wan DF_check [off]
Example
> wan DF_check on
%DF bit check enable!
> wan DF_check off
%DF bit check disable (reset DF bit)!
Example
> wan disable WAN
%WAN disabled.
Example
> wan enable WAN
%WAN1 enabled.
Syntax
wan forward [on]
wan forward [off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on/off It means to enable or disable WAN forward.
Example
> wan forward ?
%WAN forwarding is Disable!
Syntax
wan modem [init/init2/dial/pin][string]
wan modem paponly [on/off]
wan modem backup_wait [value]
wan modem pipe [Int][Din][Dout] (for USB WAN3 only)
wan modem wakeup [on/off/value] (for USB WAN3 only)
wan modem vid [id]
wan modem pid [id]
wan modem status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
init Set initial modem AT command (default value is
“AT&FE0V1X1&D2&C1S0=0”).
Init2 Set the second initial modem AT command.
dial Set dial modem AT command (default value is “ATDT*99#”).
pin Set PIN code for SIM card.
“0”:disable
paponly It means PAP Only. Set the PPP authentication of the USB WAN.
Example
> wan modem pin 0000
> wan modem status
Modem Link Speed=0
Current Signal Strength=0
Last Fail Message:
Current Connect Stage:
Syntax
wan vdsl [show basic]
wan vdsl[fbk_mode]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show basic It means to display current VDSL status.
fbk_mode It means to display current status of Fallback Mode used.
Available modes to be set as fallback mode include,
Auto
Vdsl_only
Adsl_only
Example
> wan vdsl show basic
ADSL
Link Status: TRAINING
Firmware Version: 05-04-04-04-00-01
ADSL Profile:
Basic Status Upstream Downstream Unit
Syntax
wan lte auth [0/1]
wan lte band
wan lte del [index #/all]
wan lte pass [string]
wan lte quota [-<command><parameter>l…]
wan lte read [index #/all]
wan lte reboot [-<command><parameter>l…]
wan lte reply [-<command><parameter>l…]
wan lte send [number][message]
wan lte stus
wan lte tag [index #/all]
wan lte user [string]
wan lte wms [send[cdma/gwpp]/recv[cdma/gwgw]/setting]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
auth [0/1] Set PPP authentication of LTE WAN.
0: None.
1: PAP or CHAP.
band Display working band information for LTE network connection.
del [index #/all] Delete an SMS from the LTE SIM card by specifying the index
number. Use “all” to delete all.
pass Set the password of LTE WAN.
quota Set settings of SMS Quota Limit function.
[-<command><parameter>l… Available commands with parameter are listed below:
]
[...] means that you can type in several commands in one line.
-a <0/1>: Set whether to send an e-mail alert when SMS quota
exceeded. (0: no 1: yes)
-c <cycle>: Set the order of today in refresh cycle.
-d <day>: Set the refresh day.
-e <0/1>: Enable or disable SMS Quota Limit function. (0: disable 1:
enable)
-h <hour>: Set the refresh hour.
-m <0/1/2>: Set SMS quota refresh mode. (0: None 1: monthly 2:
periodically)
Example
> wan lte band
Syntax
wan detect [wan1/wan2/wan3/wan4][on/off/always_on]
wan detect [wan1/wan2/wan3/wan4] target [ip addr]
wan detect [wan1/wan2/wan3/wan4] target2[ip addr]
wan detect [wan1/wan2/wan3/wan4] target_gw [1/0]
wan detect [wan1/wan2/wan3/wan4] ttl [value]
wan detect [wan1/wan2/wan3/wan4] interval [interval]
wan detect [wan1/wan2/wan3/wan4] retry [retry]
wan detect status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
on Enable ping detection. The IP address of the target shall be set.
off Enable ARP detection (default).
always_on Disable link detect, always connected(only support static IP)
target Set the ping target.
Target2 Set the secondary ping target.
Example
> wan detect status
WAN1: always on
WAN2: off
WAN3: off
WAN4: off
WAN5: off
> wan detect wan1 target 192.168.1.78
Set OK
Syntax
wan lb [wan1/wan2/…] on
wan lb [wan1/wan2/…] off
wan lb status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
wan1/wan2 Specify which WAN will be applied with load balance.
on Make WAN interface as the member of load balance.
off Cancel WAN interface as the member of load balance.
status Show the current status.
Example
> wan lb status
WAN1: on
WAN2: on
WAN3: on
WAN4: on
WAN5: on
WAN6: on
WAN7: on
Syntax
wan mvlan [pvc_no/status/save/enable/disable] [on/off/clear/tag tag_no] [service
type/vlan priority] [px ... ]
wan mvlan keeptag[pvc_no][on/off]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
pvc_no It means index number of PVC. There are 10 PVC, 0(Channel-1) to
9(Channel-9) allowed to be configured.
However, bridge mode can be set on PVC number 2 to 9.
status It means to display the whole Bridge status.
save It means to save the configuration into flash of Vigor router.
enable/disable It means to enable/disable the Multi-VLAN function.
on/off It means to turn on/off bridge mode for the specific channel.
clear It means to turn off/clear the port.
tag tag_no It means to tag a number for the VLAN.
Example
PVC 7 will map to LAN port 2/3/4 in bridge mode; service type is Normal. No tag added.
>
Syntax
wan multifno [channel #] [WAN interface #]
wan multifno status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
channel # There are 4 (?) channels including VLAN and PVC.
Available settings are:
1=Channel 1
3=Channel 3
4=Channel 4
5=Channel 5
WAN interface # Type a number to indicate the WAN interface.
1=WAN1
2=WAN2
status It means to display current bridge status.
Example
> wan multifno 5 1
% Configured channel 5 uplink to WAN1
> wan multifno status
% Channel 3 uplink ifno: 3
% Channel 4 uplink ifno: 3
Syntax
wan vlan wan [#] tag [value]
wan vlan wan [#] [enable/disable]
wan vlan stat
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
wan [#] Specify which WAN interface will be tagged.
tag [value] Type a number for tagging on WAN interface.
enable/disable Enable: Specified WAN interface will be tagged.
Disable: Disable the function of tagging on WAN interface.
stat Display current VLAN status.
Example
> wan vlan stat
Syntax
wan budget wan [#] rdate [day] [hour]
wan budget wan [#] [enable|disable]
wan budget wan [#] thres [budget limit (MB)]
wan budget wan [#] gthres [budget limit (GB)]
wan budget wan [#] mode [monthly|periodic|none]
wan budget wan [#] psday [th day in periodic]
wan budget wan [#] action [action bitmap]
wan budget status
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
wan[#] Specify the WAN interface.
Example
> wan budget wan 1 action 5
% WAN 1 budget action set to 5
> wan budget wan 1 gthres 10
% WAN 1 budget limit set to 10 GB
Syntax
wan detect_mtu -w [number] -i [Host/IP address] -s [base_size] -d [decrease_size] (-c
[count])
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-w [number] Specify the WAN interface.
Value: Type the number of WAN interface. 1: WAN1; 2:WAN2….and
etc.
-I [Host/IP address] Specify the IPv4 target to detect. If can be an IPv4 address or
domain name.
Host/IP address: Type the IP address/domain name of the target.
-s [base_size] Set the MTU size base for Discovery.
base_size: Available setting is 1000 ~ 1500.
-d [decrease size] Set the MTU size to decrease between detections.
decrease size: Available setting is 1 ~ 100.
-c [count] Set the maximum times of ping failure during a Discovery.
Example
> wan detect_mtu -w 2 -i 8.8.8.8 -s 1500 -d 30 -c 10
detecting mtu size:1500!!!
mtu size:1470!!!
Syntax
wan detect_mtu6 –w [number] –i [IPv6 address] –s [base_size]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-w [number] Specify the WAN interface
number: Type the number of WAN interface. 1: WAN1; 2:WAN2….and
etc.
-I [IPv6 address] Specify the IPv6 target to detect. It must be an IPv6 IP address.
IPv6 address: Type the IPv6 address of the target.
-s [base_size] Specify the size of MTU.
base_size: Available setting is 1000 ~ 1500.
Example
> wan detect_mtu6 -w 2 -i 2404:6800:4008:c06::5e -s 1500
>
Syntax
wl acl enable [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 ssid4]
wl acl disable [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 ssid4]
wl acl add [MAC] [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 ssid4] [isolate]
wl acl del [MAC]
wl acl mode [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 ssid4] [white/black]
wl acl show
wl acl showmode
wl acl clean
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 It means to enable the settings for SSID1, SSID2, SSID3 and SSID4.
ssid4]
disable [ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 It means to disable the settings for SSID1, SSID2, SSID3 and SSID4.
ssid4]
Example
> > wl acl showmode
ssid1: none
ssid2: none
ssid3: none
ssid4: none
> wl acl add 00-50-70-ff-12-70
Set Done !!
> wl acl add 00-50-70-ff-12-70 ssid1 ssid2 isolate
Set Done !!
> wl acl show
----------Enable Mac Address Filter---------
ssid1: dis ssid2: dis ssid3: dis ssid4: dis
----------MAC Address Filter----------
Index Attribute MAC Address Associated SSIDs
0 00:50:70:ff:12:70 ssid1 ssid2 ssid3 ssid4
1 s 00:50:70:ff:12:70 ssid1 ssid2
Syntax
wl config mode [value]
wl config mode show
wl config channel [number]
wl config preamble [enable]
wl config txburst [enable]
wl config ssid [ssid_num enable ssid_name [hidden_ssid]]
wl config security [SSID_NUMBER] [mode]
wl config ratectl [ssid_num enable upload download ]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
mode[value] It means to select connection mode for wireless connection.
Available settings are: "11bgn", "11gn", "11n", "11bg", "11g", or "11b".
mode show It means to display what the current wireless mode is.
channel [number] It means the channel of frequency of the wireless LAN.
The available settings are 0,1,2,3,4,5,6,7,8,9,10,11,12 and 13.
number=0, means Auto
number=1, means Channel 1
….
number=13, means Channel 13.
preamble [enable] It means to define the length of the sync field in an 802.11 packet.
Most modern wireless network uses short preamble with 56 bit sync
field instead of long preamble with 128 bit sync field. However,
some original 11b wireless network devices only support long
preamble.
0: disable to use long preamble.
1: enable to use long preamble.
txburst [enable] It means to enhance the performance in data transmission about
40%* more (by enabling Tx Burst). It is active only when both sides
of Access Point and Station (in wireless client) invoke this function
at the same time.
0: disable the function.
1: enable the funciton.
ssid[ssid_num enable It means to set the name of the SSID, hide the SSID if required.
ssid_name [hidden_ssid]] ssid_num: Type 1, 2, 3 or 4 to specify SSID1, SSID2, SSID3 or SSID4.
ssid_name: Give a name for the specified SSID.
hidden_ssid: Type 0 to hide the SSID or 1 to display the SSID
Security [SSID_NUMBER] It means to configure security settings for the wirelesss connection.
[mode][key][index] SSID_NUMBER: Type 1, 2, 3 or 4 to specify SSID1, SSID2, SSID3 or
SSID4.
mode: Available settings are:
disable: No security.
wpa1x: WPA/802.1x Only
wpa21x: WPA2/802.1x Only
wpamix1x: Mixed (WPA+WPA2/802.1x only)
wep1x: WEP/802.1x Only
wpapsk: WPA/PSK
wpa2psk: WPA2/PSK
wpamixpsk: Mixed (WPA+WPA2)/PSK
wep: WEP
key, index: Moreover, you have to add keys for wpapsk, wpa2psk,
wpamixpsk and wep, and specify index number of schedule profiles
to be followed by the wireless connection.
WEP keys must be in 5/13 ASCII text string or 10/26 Hexadecimal
digit format; WPA keys must be in 8~63 ASCII text string or 64
Hexadecimal digit format.
ratectl [ssid_num enable It means to set the rate control for the specified SSID.
upload download] ssid_num: Choose 1, 2, 3 or 4 to specify SSID1, SSID2, SSID3 or SSID4.
enable: It means to enable the function of the rate control for the
Example
> wl config mode 11bgn
Current mode is 11bgn
% <Note> Please restart wireless after you set the channel
> wl config channel 13
Current channel is 13
% <Note> Please restart wireless after you set the channel.
> wl config preamble 1
Long preamble is enabled
% <Note> Please restart wireless after you set the parameters.
> wl config ssid 1 enable dray
SSID Enable Hide_SSID Name
1 1 0 dray
% <Note> Please restart wireless after you set the parameters.
> wl config security 1 wpa1x
%% Configured Wlan Security Setting:
% SSID1
%% Mode: wpa1x
%% Wireless card must be reset for configurations to take effect
%% (Telnet Command: wl restart)
Syntax
wl set [SSID] [CHAN[En]]
wl set txburst [enable]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
SSID It means to type the SSID for the router. The maximum character
that you can use is 32.
CHAN[En] It means to specify required channel for the router.
CHAN: The range for the number is between 1 ~ 13.
En: type on to enable the function; type off to disable the function.
txburst [enable] It means to enhance the performance in data transmission about
40%* more (by enabling Tx Burst). It is active only when both sides
of Access Point and Station (in wireless client) invoke this function
at the same time.
0: disable the function.
Example
> wl set MKT 2 on
% New Wlan Setting is:
% SSID=MKT
% Chan=2
% Wl is Enable
Syntax
wl act [En]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
En It means to enable or disable the function of VPN isolation.
0: diable
1: enable
Example
> wl act on
% Set Wlan to Enable.
Syntax
wl scan [start]
wl scan set [wlist/blist/stime][MAC]
wl scan del [wlist/blist] [MAC]
wl scan filter [ssid/channel/mac]
wl scan show [0/1/2/3]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
start It means to start AP scanning.
set [wlist/blist/stime] Set white list/block list/scan time.
[MAC] wlist – It means to set white list for passing. MAC address must be
added in the end.
e.g., wl scan set wlist 001122aabbcc
blist – It means to set black list for blocking. MAC address must be
added in the end.
stime – It means to set scanning time. Time value (2~5 second) must
be added in the end.
e.g., wl scan set time 5
Example
> wl scan set wlist 001122aabbcc
> wl scan start
> wl scan show 3
>
Syntax
wl stamgt [enable/disable] [ssid_num].
wl stamgt [show] [ssid_num].
wl stamgt set [ssid_num] [c] [r]
wl stamgt reset [ssid_num].
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable/disable It means to enable/disable the station management control.
ssid_num It means channel selection.
Available channel for 2.4G: 0/1/2/3
Available channel for 5G: 4/5/6/7.
show It means to display status or configuration of the selected channel.
c It means connection time. The unit is minute.
r It means reconnection time. The unit is minute.
Example
> wl stamgt enable 1
% Station Management Status: enabled
> wl stamgt set 1 60 60
> wl stamgt show 1
NO. SSID BSSID Connect time Reconnect time
1. Draytek 00:11:22:aa:bb:cc 0d:0:58:26 0d:0:0
Syntax
wl iso_vpn [ssid] [En]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ssid It means the number of SSID.
1: SSID1
2: SSID2
3: SSID3
4: SSID4
En It means to enable or disable the function of VPN isolation.
0: disable
1: enable
Example
> wl iso_vpn 1 on
% ssid: 1 isolate vpn on :1
Syntax
wl wpa 1/2/3
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
wl wpa Type 1/2/3 to represent different WPA modes.
1 – means WPA+WPA2
2 – means WPA2 Only
3 – means WPA Only
Example
> wl wpa 1
>
Syntax
wl wmm ap QueIdx Aifsn Cwmin Cwmax Txop ACM
wl wmm bss QueIdx Aifsn Cwmin Cwmax Txop ACM
wl wmm ack Que0_Ack Que1_Ack Que2_Ack Que3_Ack
wl wmm enable SSID0 SSID1 SSID2 SSID3
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
ap It means to set WMM for access point.
bss It means to set WMM for wireless clients.
ack It means to map to the Ack policy settings of AP WMM.
enable It means to enable the WMM for each SSID.
0: disable
1: enable
Apsd [value] It means to enable / disable the ASPD(automatic power-save
delivery) function.
0: disable
1: enable
show It displays current status of WMM.
QueIdx It means the number of the queue which the WMM settings will be
applied to. There are four queues, best effort, background, voice,
and video.
Aifsn It controls how long the client waits for each data transmission.
Cwmin/ Cwmax CWMin means contention Window-Min and CWMax means
contention Window-Max. Specify the value ranging from 1 to 15.
Txop It means transmission opportunity. Specify the value ranging from 0
to 65535.
ACM It can restrict stations from using specific category class if it is
enabled.
0: disable
1: enable
Example
> wl wmm ap 0 3 4 6 0 0
QueIdx=0: APAifsn=3,APCwmin=4,APCwmax=6, APTxop=0,APACM=0
> wl wmm enable 1 0 1 0
WMM_SSID0 =1, WMM_SSID1 =0,WMM_SSID2 =1,WMM_SSID3 =0
> wl wmm show
Enable WMM: SSID0 =1, SSID1 =0,SSID2 =1,SSID3 =0
APSD=0
QueIdx=0: APAifsn=3,APCwmin=4,APCwmax=6, APTxop=0,APACM=0
QueIdx=1: APAifsn=7,APCwmin=4,APCwmax=10, APTxop=0,APACM=0
QueIdx=2: APAifsn=1,APCwmin=3,APCwmax=4, APTxop=94,APACM=0
QueIdx=3: APAifsn=1,APCwmin=2,APCwmax=3, APTxop=47,APACM=0
QueIdx=0: BSSAifsn=3,BSSCwmin=4,BSSCwmax=10, BSSTxop=0,BSSACM=0
QueIdx=1: BSSAifsn=7,BSSCwmin=4,BSSCwmax=10, BSSTxop=0,BSSACM=0
QueIdx=2: BSSAifsn=2,BSSCwmin=3,BSSCwmax=4, BSSTxop=94,BSSACM=0
QueIdx=3: BSSAifsn=2,BSSCwmin=2,BSSCwmax=3, BSSTxop=47,BSSACM=0
AckPolicy[0]=0: AckPolicy[1]=0,AckPolicy[2]=0,AckPolicy[3]=0
Syntax
wl ht bw value
wl ht gi value
wl ht badecline value
wl ht autoba value
wl ht rdg value
wl ht msdu value
wl ht txpower value
wl ht antenna value
wl ht greenfield value
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
wl ht bw value The value you can type is 0 (for BW_20) and 1 (for BW_40).
wl ht gi value The value you can type is 0 (for GI_800) and 1 (for GI_4001)
wl ht badecline value The value you can type is 0 (for disabling) and 1 (for enabling).
wl ht autoba value The value you can type is 0 (for disabling) and 1 (for enabling).
wl ht rdg value The value you can type is 0 (for disabling) and 1 (for enabling).
wl ht msdu value The value you can type is 0 (for disabling) and 1 (for enabling).
wl ht txpower value The value you can type ranges from 1 – 6 (level).
wl ht antenna value The value you can type ranges from 0-3.
0: 2T3R
1: 2T2R
2: 1T2R
3: 1T1R
wl ht greenfield value The value you can type is 0 (for mixed mode) and 1 (for green field).
Example
> wl ht bw value 1
BW=0
<Note> Please restart wireless after you set new parameters.
> wl restart
Wireless restart................
Example
> wl restart
Wireless restart................
Syntax
wl btnctl [value]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
value 0: disable
1: enable
Example
> wl btnctl 1
Enable wireless botton control
Current wireless botton control is on
>
Syntax
wan vlan wan [#] tag [value]
wan vlan wan [#] [enable|disable]
wan vlan stat
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
# It means the number of WAN interface.
1: means WAN1
2: means WAN2.
value It means the number to be tagged on packets.
The range of the value is between 32 ~ 4095.
enable|disable It means to enable or disable the WAN interface for VLAN.
Example
> wan vlan stat
%Interface Pri Tag Enabled
%======================================
% WAN1 (ADSL) 0 0
% WAN1 (VDSL) 0 0
%WAN2 0 0
Syntax
wol up [MAC Address]/[IP Address]
wol fromWan [on/off/any]
wol fromWan_Setting [idx][ip address][mask]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
MAC Address It means the MAC address of the host.
IP address It means the LAN IP address of the host. If you want to wake up LAN
host by using IP address, be sure that that IP address has been
bound with the MAC address (IP BindMAC).
on/off/any It means to enable or disable the function of WOL from WAN.
on: enable
off: disable
any: It means any source IP address can pass through NAT and wake
up the LAN client.
This command will allow the user to choose whether WoL packets
can be passed from the Internet to the LAN network from a specific
WAN interface.
[idx][ip address] [mask] It means the index number (from 1 to 4).
These commands will allow the user to configure the LAN clients
that the user may wake up from the Internet through the use of the
WoL packet.
ip address - It means the WAN IP address.
mask - It means the mask of the IP address.
Example
> wol fromWan on
> wol fromWan_Setting 1 192.168.1.45 255.255.255.0
>
Syntax
sser set [-e|-d|-c|-l|-o|-a|-r|-b]
user edit [PROFILE_IDX] [-e|-d|-n|-p|-t|-u|-i|-q|-r|-w|-s|-m|-x|-v]
user account [USER_NAME] [-t|-d|-q|-r|-w]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
set It means to configure general setup for the user management.
edit It means to modify the selected user profile.
account It means to set time and data quota for specified user account.
User Set
-e Enable User management function.
-d Disable User management function.
-a[Profile idx][User It means to pass an IP Address.
name][IP_Address] Profile idx- type the index number of the selected profile.
User name- type the user name that you want it to pass.
IP_Address- type the IP address that you want it to pass.
-l all Show online user.
-l userl all – all of the users will be displayed on the screen.
-l ip user name – type the user name that you want to view on the
screen.
ip – type the IP address that you want to view on the screen.
-o It means to show user account information.
e.g.,-o
-c[user name] Clear the user record.
-c all user name – type the user name that you want to get clear
corresponding record.
all – all of the records will be removed.
-buser [user name] Block specifies user or IP address.
-b ip [ ip address] user name – type the user name that you want to block.
ip address –– type the IP address that you want to block.
-u user [user name] Unblock specifies user or IP address.
-u ip [ ip address] user name – type the user name that you want to unblock.
ip address –– type the IP address that you want to unblock.
-r [user name | all] Remove the user record.
user name – type the name of the user profile.
all – all of the user profile settings will be removed.
-q It means to trigger the alert tool to do authentication.
-s It means to set login service.
0:HTTPS
1:HTTP
e.g.,-s 1
User edit
Syntax
nand bad
nand usage
Example
>nand usage
Show NAND Flash Usage:
Partition Total Used Available Use%
cfg 4194304 7920 4186384 0%
bin_web 33554432 11869493 21684939 35%
cfg-bak 4194304 7920 4186384 0%
bin_web-bak 33554432 11869493 21684939 35%
> nand bad
Show NAND Flash Bad Blocks:
Block Address Partition
1020 0x07f80000 unused
1021 0x07fa0000 unused
1022 0x07fc0000 unused
1023 0x07fe0000 unused
Syntax
apm show
apm clear
apm discover
apm query
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show It displays current information of APM profile.
clear It is used to remove all of the APM profile.
discover It is used to search VigorAP on LAN.
query It is used to query any VigorAP which has been registered to APM
(Central AP Management) in Vigor2860. Information related to the
registered AP will be send back to Vigor2860 for updating the web
page of Central AP Management.
Syntax
apm profile clone [from index][to index][[new name]
apm profile del [index]
apm profile reset
apm profile summary
apm profile [show [profile index]]
apm profile apply [profile index] [client index1 [index2 .. index5]]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
clone It is used to copy the same parameters settings from one profile to
another APM profile.
del It is used to delete a specified APM profile. The default (index #1)
should not be deleted.
reset It is used to reset to factory settings for WLAN profile.
summary It is used to list all of the APM profiles with required information.
show It is used to display specified APM profile.
apply It is used to apply the selected APM profile onto specified VigorAP.
from index Type an index number in this field. It is the original APM profile to
be cloned to other APM profile.
to index Type an index number in this file. It is the target profile which will
clone the parameters settings from an existed APM profile.
new name Type a name for a new APM profile.
profile index Type the index number of existed profile.
client index1/2/3/4/5 It is useful for applying the selected APM profile to the specified
VigorAP.
Example
> apm profile clone 1 2 forcarrie
(Done)
1 - - - - -
2 forcarrie DrayTek Disable x - / -
Syntax
apm cache [show]
apm cache clear
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show It means to display the information related to VigorAP registered
Vigor2860.
clear It means to remove the information related to VigorAP registered
Vigor2860.
Example
> apm cache show
MAC Name Auth
------------ -------------------- --------------------
>
Syntax
apm lbcfg [set] [value]
apm lbcfg[show]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
set It means to set the load balance configuration file for APM.
Show It shows the configuration value.
[value] You need to type 10 numbers in this field. Each number represents
different setting value.
[1] – The first number means the load balance function. Type
1 – enable load balance,
0 – disable load balance.
[2] – The second number means the station limit function. Type
1 –enable station limit,
0 – disable station limit.
[3] – The third number means the traffic limit function. Type
1 – enable traffic limit,
0 – disable traffic limit.
Example
> apm lbcfg show
apm LoadBalance Config :
1. Enable LoadBalance : 0
2. Enable station limit : 0
3. Enable traffic limit : 0
4. limit Number : 64
5. Upload limit : 0
6. Download limit : 0
7. Enable disassociation by idle time : 0
8. Enable disassociation by Signal strength : 0
9. Traffic limit unit (upload) : 0
10.Traffic limit unit (download) : 0
flag : 0
> apm lbcfg set 1 1 0 15 0 0 0 0 1 1
> apm lbcfg show
apm LoadBalance Config :
1. Enable LoadBalance : 1
2. Enable station limit : 1
3. Enable traffic limit : 0
4. limit Number : 15
5. Upload limit : 0
6. Download limit : 0
7. Enable disassociation by idle time : 0
8. Enable disassociation by Signal strength : 0
9. Traffic limit unit (upload) : 1
Syntax
apm napdetect [get]
apm napdetect [set] [enable/disable AP Detection 1/0][Refresh Time].
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Example
Note: To check the scanning result of AP detection, use the command of “wl scan show”.
> apm napdetect set 1 1
> wl scan show 3
Sta Ch SSID BSSID BssType Security Siganl(%) Beacon
Period First Detected Last Detected
11 DrayTek-LAN-B 02:1d:aa:4c:bd:a8 AP Mixed 26 100
11 DrayTek-LAN-A 00:1d:aa:4f:bd:a8 AP Mixed 42 100
Dec 09,10:35:44 Dec 09,10:35:44
Syntax
apm apsyslog [AP_Index]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
AP_Index Specify the index number which represents VigorAP.
Example
> apm apsyslog 1
8d 02:46:09 syslog: [APM] Send Rogue AP Detection data.
8d 02:53:04 syslog: [APM] Run AP Detection / Discovery.
8d 02:56:09 syslog: [APM] Send Rogue AP Detection data.
8d 03:00:42 kernel: 60:fa:cd:55:f5:ea had disassociated.
8d 03:03:12 syslog: [APM] Run AP Detection / Discovery.
8d 03:06:09 syslog: [APM] Send Rogue AP Detection data.
Syntax
apm syslog
Example
> apm syslog
"2015-11-04 12:24:21", "[APM] [VigorAP900_01daa902080] Get Rogue AP Detection
Data from AP"
2015-11-04 12:24:56", "[APM] [VigorAP900_01daa902080] Get Rogue AP Detection
Data from AP Success"
2015-11-04 12:34:21", "[APM] [VigorAP900_01daa902080] Get Rogue AP Detection
Data from AP"
2015-11-04 12:34:57", "[APM] [VigorAP900_01daa902080] Get Rogue AP Detection
Data from AP Success"
Syntax
apm stanum [AP_Index]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
AP_Index Specify the index number which represents VigorAP.
Example
> apm stanum
Syntax
ha set [-<command> <parameter>| ... ]
Syntax Description
>
Syntax
ha show –c
ha show –g
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
-c Show the settings of config sync.
-g Show the settings of general setup.
Example
> ha show -g
% High Availability : Disable
% Redundancy Method : Active-Standby
% Group ID : 1
% Priority ID : 10
% Preempt Mode : Enable
% Update DDNS : Disable
% Management Interface : LAN1
% Authentication Key : draytek
% Syslog : OFF
%
% [ Index | Enable | Virtual IP ]
% LAN1 On 192.168.1.0
% LAN2 - 0.0.0.0
% LAN3 - 0.0.0.0
% LAN4 - 0.0.0.0
% LAN5 - 0.0.0.0
% LAN6 - 0.0.0.0
% DMZ - 0.0.0.0
% [ Index | Enable | Virtual IPv6 ]
% LAN1 On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% LAN2 On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% LAN3 On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% LAN4 On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% LAN5 On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% LAN6 On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% DMZ On FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
>
Syntax
ha status –a [Detail Level]
ha status –m [Detail Level]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
Example
> ha status -m 2
% [Local Router] DrayTek
% IP : 192.168.1.1 (FE80::21D:AAFF:FEC6:4C50)
% Status : !
% High Availability : ! Disable
% Redundancy Method : Active-Standby
% Group ID : 1
% Priority ID : 10
% Update DDNS : Disable
% Protocol : IPv4
% Management Interface: LAN1
% Authentication Key : draytek
% Virtual IP: (Max. 7 Virtual IPs)
% ON LAN1 192.168.1.0
% Virtual IPv6: (Max. 7 Virtual IPv6s)
% ON LAN1 FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% ON LAN2 FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% ON LAN3 FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% ON LAN4 FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% ON LAN5 FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% ON LAN6 FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% ON DMZ FE80::200:5EFF:FE00:101
% Config Sync : Disable
% Config Sync Interval : 0 Day 0 Hour 15 Minute
% Cached Time : 0 (s)
>
Syntax
swm show [LAN_port]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
LAN_port Specify the LAN port number (1 to 6).
Example
> swm show
Syntax
swm get [LAN_port]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
LAN_port Specify the LAN port number (1 to 6).
Example
> swm get 1
Syntax
swm post [LAN_port]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
LAN_port Specify the LAN port number (1 to 6).
Example
> swm post 1
Start post cfg to LAN (1) external switch with currect settings.
Please wait a few seconds...
Result: [OK]
>
Syntax
swm auth [show/clear]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
show Display recorded external switch MAC address list.
clear Clear specific index of authentication record table.
Index range: (1 - 30)
Syntax
swm extvlan [LAN_Port][VLAN_idx][Port_Description]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
LAN_Port Setting range is from 1 to 6.
VLAN_idx Index number range for VLAN is from 0 to 7.
Port_Description Setting range is from 1 to 24.
Example
> swm extvlan 1 1 13
Set OK.
> swm post 1
Start post cfg to LAN (1) external switch with currect settings.//post cfg
Please wait a few seconds...
Result: [OK].
System will cover the original VLAN settings on your VigorSwitch. Please backup the
configuration file before you run this function.
System also will select the physical connect port as trunk port and let it join each VLAN group.
Before using such command, please use [swm show] to check valid VLAN index firstly.
Syntax
appqos view
appqos enable [0/1]
appqos traceable [-v | -e AP_INDEX CLASS | -d AP_INDEX]
appqos untraceable [-v | -e AP_INDEX CLASS | -d AP_INDEX]
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
view It means to display current status of APP QoS.
enable[0/1] It means to enable or disable the function of APP QoS.
traceable/ untraceable The APPs are divided into traceable and untraceable based on their
properties.
-v It means to view the content of all traceable APs.
Example
> appqos enable 1
Syntax
local_8021x enable [0/1]
local_8021x set_localdot1x_phase1 options...
local_8021x set_localdot1x_phase2 options...
local_8021x show
Syntax Description
Parameter Description
enable Enable or disable the configuration.
0: disable.
1: enable.
set_localdot1x_phase1 Only support PEAP now. The method_idx for such phase1 is “1”.
set_localdot1x_phase2 Only support MS-CHAPv2 now. The method_idx for such phase2 is
“1”.
options -e [method_idx]: set method.
e.g, local_8021x set_localdot1x_phase1 -e 1
-d: delete mehod.
e.g, local_8021x set_localdot1x_phase1 -d
show Display current settings of local 802.1x server.
Example
> local_8021x show
% Local 802.1X enable: enable
6 Anonymous, 207
Antenna Installation, 3
6rd Mode, 124
AP Discovery, 105, 291
6rd Prefix, 124
AP Maintenance, 561, 569
6rd Prefix Length, 124
AP Map, 561, 570
Account Number, 309 ARP Detect, 83, 86, 90, 93, 97, 99, 104, 108, 110, 112, 130
Auto detect, 37
CLIR, 321
Codepage, 407
B
Comment, 167, 184
Backup, 167
Common Name Identifier, 209
Backup Phone Number, 313
Config Backup, 31
Band Steering, 294
Config Sync, 221
Bandwidth Limit, 492, 496
Configuration Backup, 472
Bandwidth Management, 492
Connection Management, 369
Barring Type, 317
Connection Type, 193
Base Distinguished Name, 209
Connectivity, 67
Beacon Period, 576
Country Code, 289
Bind IP to MAC, 166
CPE Management, 543
Bind to WAN, 381
CSM, 428
Bind Type, 207
CSV file, 600
Bogus DNS Reply, 198
Current System Time, 200
Bonjour, 215
Bridge Subnet, 94, 100, 119, 121 Data Coding Scheme, 262
Details-IPv6-6rd, 123 DNS Server IP Address, 88, 96, 101, 129, 153, 155
DHCP, 48, 54
Failover to/Failback, 232 Idle Timeout, 91, 98, 103, 129, 131
Fixed IP, 84, 91, 98, 103, 129, 131 Incoming Port, 188
IP Based, 72
H IP Bind List, 167
ISP Access Setup, 83, 91, 96, 102 Long Preamble, 288
Main Screen, 22
L
Maintenance, 592
LAN, 148
Management, 481
LAN DNS / DNS Forwarding, 189, 195
Management Interface, 221
LAN Port Mirror, 168
Manually ULA Prefix, 158
LAN Routed Prefix, 122
MBS, 132
LAN to LAN, 348
Min/Max Interval Time, 160
Landing Page, 518, 522
Mirror Port, 168
LDAP /Active Directory Setup, 189
Mode, 271, 278
Lease Time, 152, 154, 157
Modem Code Upgrade, 489
Line Speed, 72, 73, 76, 78
Modem Dial String, 108
Load Balance, 74, 76, 78, 254, 579
Modem Initial String, 57, 108
Load Balance for AP, 561
Modem Initial String2, 108
Load Balance Mode, 72
Modem Setting (for ADSL only), 82, 86
Load-Balance, 238
Modem Settings, 89
Load-Balance /Route Policy, 238
Modem Settings (for ADSL only), 93
Local 802.1X, 491, 523
Modem Support List, 107, 109, 635
Physical Connection, 32
N Physical Members, 127, 129
Neighbor AP Detection, 575 Ping Detect, 83, 86, 90, 93, 97, 99, 104, 108, 110, 112, 115, 116,
117, 119, 121, 122, 124, 130
Network Configuration, 152, 154, 156
Ping Diagnosis, 650
Network Interface, 237
Ping Gateway IP, 83, 86, 90, 93, 97, 99, 104, 108, 110, 112, 130
Network Mode, 110, 111
Ping Interval, 83, 86, 90, 93, 97, 99, 104, 108, 110, 112, 130
Next Server IP Address/SIAddr, 151
PING Interval, 99
Non-temporary Address, 119
Ping IP/Hostname, 115, 116, 117, 119, 121, 122, 124
Notification Object, 620
Ping Retry, 83, 86, 90, 93, 97, 99, 104, 108, 110, 112, 130
NS Detect, 119
Policy, 521
Number of Spatial Streams (NSS), 288
Port Redirection, 177
PPPoE/PPPoA, 37
SIP, 300
Subnet Mask, 87, 95, 101, 103, 104, 129, 152, 154 TSPC, 115
Subnet Prefix, 117 TTL (Time to Live), 83, 86, 90, 93, 97, 99, 104, 108, 110, 112, 115,
116, 117, 119, 121, 122, 124, 130
Support List, 593
Tunnel, 136
Switch, 584
Tunnel Broker, 116, 117
Switch Group, 590
Tunnel ID, 117
Switch Hierarchy, 586
Tunnel TTL, 122
Switch Status, 584
TX Power, 289
Sync User Profile, 223
TxBURST, 288
Syslog Alarm, 634
Username, 83, 91, 96, 101, 102, 116, 117, 129, 131 WAN Application-Management, 129